Shamsan | N6 CIF Series | N6 Series DVR User`s Manual V6.5.0 201308

N6 Series DVR User`s Manual V6.5.0 201308
N6 Series Standalone DVR User’s Manual
Version 6.5.0
Table of Contents
1
FEATURES AND SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................. 1
1.1
Overview ................................................................................................................................................. 1
1.2
Features .................................................................................................................................................. 1
1.3
Specifications ......................................................................................................................................... 2
2
1.3.1
1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series ...................................................................................................... 2
1.3.2
1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series .......................................................................................................... 5
1.3.3
Enhanced 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series ................................................................................... 8
1.3.4
Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series ..................................................................................... 11
1.3.5
General 2CIF Real-time Mini 1U Series ...................................................................................... 14
1.3.6
General Full-D1 Mini 1U Series .................................................................................................... 18
1.3.7
Enhanced 2CIF Real-time Mini 1U Series .................................................................................. 21
1.3.8
Enhanced Full-D1 Mini 1U Series ................................................................................................ 24
1.3.9
Economic 2CIF Mini 1U Series ..................................................................................................... 27
1.3.10
General 1U Series ..................................................................................................................... 30
1.3.11
960H 1U Series .......................................................................................................................... 34
1.3.12
HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series ......................................................................................................... 37
1.3.13
2HDD 1U Entry-level Series ..................................................................................................... 40
1.3.14
Full-D1 1.5U Series.................................................................................................................... 43
1.3.15
HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series ...................................................................................................... 46
1.3.16
2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series ..................................................................................... 50
1.3.17
4HDD Full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series .................................................................................... 53
1.3.18
4/8/16-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series .......................................................................................... 57
1.3.19
24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series ........................................................................................... 60
1.3.20
2HDD CIF 1.5U Series .............................................................................................................. 64
1.3.21
Simple 1.5 U Series ................................................................................................................... 67
1.3.22
960H 4HDD 1.5U Series ........................................................................................................... 70
1.3.23
960H 2HDD 1.5U Series ........................................................................................................... 73
1.3.24
General 2U Series ..................................................................................................................... 77
1.3.25
HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series ......................................................................................................... 80
1.3.26
960H 2U Series .......................................................................................................................... 83
1.3.27
8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series ....................................................................................... 87
1.3.28
24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series .......................................................................................................... 90
OVERVIEW AND CONTROLS
CONTROLS ......................................................................... 94
i
2.1
Front Panel ........................................................................................................................................... 94
2.1.1
4/8-Channel Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series .............................................................. 94
2.1.2
1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U/1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series /Enhanced 1HDD Full-D1 Smart
1U/16-Channel Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series ........................................................................ 94
2.1.3
4/8-Channel General 2CIF Mini 1U/ 4/8-Channel Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U ........................... 95
2.1.4
16-Channel General 2CIF Mini 1U/ 16-Channel Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U ............................. 96
2.1.5
Economic 2CIF Mini 1U ................................................................................................................. 97
2.1.6
General 1U Series .......................................................................................................................... 98
2.1.7
960H 1U Series /2HDD 1U Entry-level Series/ HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series............................. 99
2.1.8
Full-D1 1.5U and Simple 1.5U Series ........................................................................................ 101
2.1.9
HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series/960H 1.5U Series/2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series/4HDD
full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series/(4/8/16/24/32-channel)2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/2HDD CIF 1.5U
Series 103
2.1.10
General 2U Series/960H Series/ HD-SDI Series/8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series /
24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series............................................................................................................................ 104
2.2
Rear Panel .......................................................................................................................................... 106
2.2.1
General 2CIF Mini 1U Series ...................................................................................................... 107
2.2.2
Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U Series .................................................................................................. 108
2.2.3
General Mini 1U Series ................................................................................................................ 109
2.2.4
Enhanced Mini 1U Series ............................................................................................................ 110
2.2.5
Economic 2CIF mini 1U Series ................................................................................................... 112
2.2.6
1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series /1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series ............................................. 113
2.2.7
Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series ................................................................................... 114
2.2.8
Enhanced 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series ............................................................................... 115
2.2.9
General 1U Series ........................................................................................................................ 115
2.2.10
960H 1U Series ........................................................................................................................ 116
2.2.11
HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series ....................................................................................................... 117
2.2.12
2HDD 1U Entry-level Series ................................................................................................... 117
2.2.13
Full-D1 1.5U Series.................................................................................................................. 118
2.2.14
2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/Simple 1.5U Series ....................................................................... 119
2.2.15
2HDD CIF 1.5U Series/24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U ............................................................ 119
2.2.16
HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series .................................................................................................... 120
2.2.17
960H 4HDD 1.5U Series ......................................................................................................... 121
2.2.18
960H 2HDD 1.5U Series ......................................................................................................... 122
2.2.19
2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series ................................................................................... 122
2.2.20
4HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series ................................................................................... 123
2.2.21
General 2U Series/24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series ....................................................................... 124
2.2.22
HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series ...................................................................................................... 126
2.2.23
960H 2U Series ........................................................................................................................ 127
2.2.24
8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level ................................................................................................. 128
2.3
2.3.1
Connection Sample
Sample ........................................................................................................................... 129
Smart 1U/Mini 1U Series ............................................................................................................. 129
ii
2.3.2
General 1U Series ........................................................................................................................ 130
2.3.3
960H 1U Series ............................................................................................................................. 131
2.3.4
HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series ............................................................................................................ 132
2.3.5
2HDD 1U Entry-level Series/2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series...................................... 133
2.3.6
General 1.5U Series ..................................................................................................................... 134
2.3.7
HD-SDI 1.5U Series ..................................................................................................................... 135
2.3.8
2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/Simple1.5U Series ............................................................................. 136
2.3.9
2HDD CIF 1.5U Series/24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U ................................................................. 137
2.3.10
960H 4HDD 1.5U Series ......................................................................................................... 138
2.3.11
960H 2HDD 1.5U Series ......................................................................................................... 139
2.3.12
4HDD Full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series .................................................................................. 140
2.3.13
General 2U series/24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series ....................................................................... 141
2.3.14
HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series ....................................................................................................... 142
2.3.15
960H 2U Series ........................................................................................................................ 143
2.3.16
8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series ..................................................................................... 144
2.4
Remote Control .................................................................................................................................. 145
2.5
Mouse Control .................................................................................................................................... 147
2.6
Virtual Keyboard & Front Panel ....................................................................................................... 149
2.6.1
Virtual Keyboard............................................................................................................................ 149
2.6.2
Front Panel .................................................................................................................................... 149
3
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
CONNECTIONS........................................................... 150
3.1
Check Unpacked DVR ...................................................................................................................... 150
3.2
About Front Panel and Real Panel ................................................................................................. 150
3.3
HDD Installation ................................................................................................................................. 150
3.3.1
SMART 1U Series ........................................................................................................................ 151
3.3.2
Mini 1U/1U Series ......................................................................................................................... 152
3.3.3
1.5U series ..................................................................................................................................... 152
3.3.4
2U series (HD-SDI series, 960H ) ......................................................................................... 153
3.4
Rack Installation.................................................................................................................................
154
Installation
3.5
Connecting Power Supply ................................................................................................................ 154
iii
3.6
Connecting Video Input and Output Devices ................................................................................ 154
3.6.1
Connecting Video Input ................................................................................................................ 154
3.6.2
Connecting Video Output............................................................................................................. 154
3.7
Connecting Audio Input & Output, Bidirectional Audio ................................................................ 155
3.7.1
Audio Input ..................................................................................................................................... 155
3.7.2
Audio Output .................................................................................................................................. 155
3.8
Alarm Input and Output Connection ............................................................................................... 155
3.8.1
Alarm Input and Output Details ................................................................................................... 156
3.8.2
Alarm Input Port ............................................................................................................................ 164
3.8.3
Alarm Output Port ......................................................................................................................... 165
3.9
RS232..................................................................................................................................................
RS232
165
3.10
RS485..................................................................................................................................................
166
RS485
3.11
Other Interfaces ................................................................................................................................. 166
4
OVERVIEW OF NAVIGATION
NAVIGATION AND CONTROLS .......................................... 168
4.1
Login, Logout & Main Menu ............................................................................................................. 168
4.1.1
Login ............................................................................................................................................... 168
4.1.2
Main Menu ..................................................................................................................................... 169
4.1.3
Logout ............................................................................................................................................. 169
4.1.4
Auto Resume after Power Failure .............................................................................................. 170
4.1.5
Replace Button Battery ................................................................................................................ 170
4.2
Live Viewing ....................................................................................................................................... 170
4.3
Manual
Manual Record ................................................................................................................................... 171
4.3.1
Manual record menu..................................................................................................................... 172
4.3.2
Basic operation.............................................................................................................................. 172
4.3.3
Enable/disable record................................................................................................................... 172
4.3.4
Enable all channel recording ....................................................................................................... 173
4.3.5
Stop all channel recording ........................................................................................................... 173
iv
4.4
Search & Playback ............................................................................................................................ 174
4.4.1
Smart Search ................................................................................................................................. 178
4.4.2
Accurate playback by time........................................................................................................... 178
4.4.3
Mark Playback ............................................................................................................................... 179
4.5
Schedule ............................................................................................................................................. 180
4.5.1
Schedule Menu ............................................................................................................................. 180
4.5.2
Snapshot ........................................................................................................................................ 183
4.5.3
Image FTP ..................................................................................................................................... 185
4.6
Detect .................................................................................................................................................. 185
4.6.1
Go to Detect Menu ........................................................................................................................ 185
4.6.2
Motion Detect ................................................................................................................................ 186
4.6.3
Video Loss ..................................................................................................................................... 189
4.6.4
Camera Masking ........................................................................................................................... 190
4.7
Alarm Setup and Alarm Activation .................................................................................................. 191
4.7.1
Go to alarm setup interface ......................................................................................................... 191
4.7.2
Alarm setup .................................................................................................................................... 191
4.8
Backup ................................................................................................................................................ 194
4.7.1 Detect Device..................................................................................................................................... 194
4.8.1
4.9
Backup ............................................................................................................................................ 194
PTZ Control and Color Setup .......................................................................................................... 195
4.8.1 Cable Connection .............................................................................................................................. 195
4.8.2 PTZ Setup ........................................................................................................................................... 196
4.8.3 3D Intelligent Positioning Key.......................................................................................................... 197
4.10
Preset/ Patrol/Pattern/Scan..............................................................................................................
198
Patrol/Pattern/Scan
4.9.1Preset Setup ....................................................................................................................................... 199
4.9.2 Activate Preset................................................................................................................................... 199
4.9.3 Patrol setup (Tour Setup) ................................................................................................................. 199
4.9.4 Activate Patrol (tour) ......................................................................................................................... 200
4.9.5 Pattern Setup ..................................................................................................................................... 200
4.9.6 Activate Pattern Function ................................................................................................................. 200
4.9.7 Auto Scan Setup ............................................................................................................................... 200
4.9.8 Activate Auto Scan ............................................................................................................................ 200
4.11
Flip ....................................................................................................................................................... 200
v
5
UNDERSTANDING OF MENU
MENU OPERATIONS AND CONTRO
CONTROLS
TROLS ................. 202
5.1
Menu Tree .......................................................................................................................................... 202
5.2
Main Menu .......................................................................................................................................... 202
5.3
Setting ................................................................................................................................................. 203
5.3.1
General ........................................................................................................................................... 203
5.3.2
Encode ........................................................................................................................................... 206
5.3.3
Schedule ........................................................................................................................................ 208
5.3.4
RS232 ............................................................................................................................................. 208
5.3.5
Network .......................................................................................................................................... 209
5.3.6
Alarm............................................................................................................................................... 227
5.3.7
Detect ............................................................................................................................................. 227
5.3.8
Pan/Tilt/Zoom ................................................................................................................................ 227
5.3.9
Display ............................................................................................................................................ 227
5.3.10
Default........................................................................................................................................ 231
5.4
Search ................................................................................................................................................. 232
5.5
Advanced ............................................................................................................................................ 232
5.5.1
HDD Management ........................................................................................................................ 232
5.5.2
Abnormality .................................................................................................................................... 237
5.5.3
Alarm Output.................................................................................................................................. 237
5.5.4
Manual Record .............................................................................................................................. 238
5.5.5
Account........................................................................................................................................... 238
5.5.6
Auto Maintenance ......................................................................................................................... 241
5.5.7
TV Adjust ........................................................................................................................................ 241
5.5.8
Video Matrix ................................................................................................................................... 241
5.5.9
Card Overlay.................................................................................................................................. 242
5.5.10
5.6
Config Backup .......................................................................................................................... 244
Information .......................................................................................................................................... 245
5.6.1
HDD Information ........................................................................................................................... 245
5.6.2
BPS ................................................................................................................................................. 246
5.6.3
Log .................................................................................................................................................. 246
5.6.4
Version ........................................................................................................................................... 248
5.6.5
Online Users .................................................................................................................................. 248
5.6.6
Network Information ..................................................................................................................... 249
vi
5.7
6
Shutdown ............................................................................................................................................ 250
ABOUT AUXILIARY MENU ............................................................................ 252
6.1
Go to Pan/Tilt/Zoom Menu ............................................................................................................... 252
6.1.1
6.2
3D Intelligent Positioning Key ..................................................................................................... 252
Preset /Patrol / Pattern /Border Function ..................................................................................... 253
6.2.1
Preset Setup .................................................................................................................................. 254
6.2.2
Activate Preset .............................................................................................................................. 254
6.2.3
Patrol Setup ................................................................................................................................... 254
6.2.4
Activate Patrol ............................................................................................................................... 254
6.2.5
Pattern Setup ................................................................................................................................. 254
6.2.6
Activate Pattern Function............................................................................................................. 255
6.2.7
Border Setup.................................................................................................................................. 255
6.2.8
Activate Border Function ............................................................................................................. 255
1.1.1 Flip ........................................................................................................................................................ 255
7
WEB OPERATION .......................................................................................... 257
7.1
Network Connection .......................................................................................................................... 257
7.2
Login .................................................................................................................................................... 257
7.3
LAN Mode ........................................................................................................................................... 259
7.4
RealReal-time Monitor .............................................................................................................................. 261
7.5
PTZ ...................................................................................................................................................... 261
7.6
Image/Relay262
Image/Relay-out.................................................................................................................................
out
7.6.1
Image .............................................................................................................................................. 262
7.6.2
Relay output ................................................................................................................................... 263
7.6.3
Multiple-channel preview ............................................................................................................. 263
7.7
WAN Login.......................................................................................................................................... 263
vii
7.8
Setup ................................................................................................................................................... 265
7.8.1
Channel .......................................................................................................................................... 265
7.8.2
Network .......................................................................................................................................... 271
7.8.3
Event ............................................................................................................................................... 286
7.8.4
Storage ........................................................................................................................................... 295
7.8.5
System ............................................................................................................................................ 299
7.8.6
Advanced ....................................................................................................................................... 311
7.8.7
Information ..................................................................................................................................... 313
7.9
Search ................................................................................................................................................. 315
7.10
Alarm ................................................................................................................................................... 318
7.11
Log out ................................................................................................................................................ 318
7.12
7.12
UnUn-install Web Control ...................................................................................................................... 319
8
PROFESSIONAL SURVEILLANCE
SURVEILLANCE SYSTEM ................................................ 320
9
FAQ................................................................................................................. 321
APPENDIX A HDD CAPACITY CALCULATION
CALCULATION ................................................. 327
APPENDIX B COMPATIBLE BACKUP DEVICE
328
DEVICE LIST........................................
LIST
APPENDIX C COMPATIBLE
COMPATIBLE CD/DVD
CD/DVD DEVICE LIST ........................................... 334
APPENDIX D COMPATIBLE DISPLAYER LIST ................................................. 335
APPENDIX E COMPATIBLE SWITCHER LIST .................................................. 336
APPENDIX F
COMPATIBLE WIRELESS MOUSE LIST ..................................... 337
viii
APPENDIX G EARTHING .................................................................................... 338
APPENDIX H TOXIC OR HAZARDOUS
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS OR ELEMENTS ................ 343
ix
Welcome
Thank you for purchasing our DVR!
This user’s manual is designed to be a reference tool for the installation and operation of your
system.
Here you can find information about this series DVR features and functions, as well as a detailed
menu tree.
Before installation and operation please read the following safeguards and warnings carefully!
x
Important Safeguards and Warnings
1.
.Electrical safety
All installation and operation here should conform to your local electrical safety codes.
We assume no liability or responsibility for all the fires or electrical shock caused by improper
handling or installation.
2.
.Transportation security
Heavy stress, violent vibration or water splash are not allowed during transportation, storage and
installation.
3.
.Installation
Keep upwards. Handle with care.
Do not apply power to the DVR before completing installation.
Do not place objects on the DVR
4.
.Qualified engineers needed
All the examination and repair work should be done by the qualified service engineers.
We are not liable for any problems caused by unauthorized modifications or attempted repair.
5.
.Environment
The DVR should be installed in a cool, dry place away from direct sunlight, inflammable,
explosive substances and etc.
This series product shall be transported, storage and used in the specified environments.
6. Accessories
Be sure to use all the accessories recommended by manufacturer.
Before installation, please open the package and check all the components are included.
Contact your local retailer ASAP if something is broken in your package.
7. Lithium battery
Improper battery use may result in fire, explosion, or personal injury!
When replace the battery, please make sure you are using the same model!
xi
1 FEATURES AND SPECIFICATIONS
1.1 Overview
This series product is an excellent digital monitor product designed for security field. It adopts
embedded Linux OS to maintain reliable operation. Popular H.264 compression algorithm and
G.711 audio compression technology realize high quality, low bit stream. Unique frame by frame
play function is suitable for detail analysis. It has various functions such as record, playback,
monitor at the same time and can guarantee audio video synchronization. This series product
has advanced technology and strong network data transmission function.
This series device adopts embedded design to achieve high security and reliability. It can work in
the local end, and at the same time, when connecting it to the professional surveillance software
(PSS), it can connect to security network to realize strong network and remote monitor function.
This series product can be widely used in various areas such as banking, telecommunication,
electric power, interrogation, transportation, intelligent resident zone, factory, warehouse,
resources, and water conservancy.
1.2 Features
This series product has the following features:
Real-time monitor
It has analog output port, VGA port and HDMI port. You can use monitor or displayer to realize
surveillance function.
System supports TV/VGA/HDMI output at the same time.
Storage function
Special data format to guarantee data security and can avoid vicious data modification.
Compression format
Support multiple-channel audio and video. An independent hardware decodes the audio and
video signal from each channel to maintain video and audio synchronization.
Backup function
Support backup operation via USB port (such as flash disk, portable HDD, burner).
Client-end user can download the file to local HDD to backup via network.
Record playback function
Support each channel real-time record independently, and at the same time it can support search,
forward play, network monitor, record search, download and etc.
Support various playback modes: slow play, fast play, backward play and frame by frame play.
Support time title overlay so that you can view event accurate occurred time
Support specified zone enlargement.
Network operation
1
Support network remote real-time monitor, remote record search and remote PTZ control.
Alarm activation function
Several relay alarm outputs to realize alarm activation and on-site light control.
The alarm input port and output has the protection circuit to guarantee device safety.
Communication port
RS485 port can realize alarm input and PTZ control.
RS232 port can connect to keyboard to realize central control, and can also connect to PC COM
to upgrade system and realize maintenance, and matrix control.
Standard Ethernet port can realize network access function.
Dual Ethernet ports support configuration modes such as multiple access, Fault-tolerance and
load balancing.
PTZ control
Support PTZ decoder via RS485.
Support various decode protocols to allow the PTZ to control the speed dome.
Intelligent operation
Mouse operation function
In the menu, support copy and paste setup function
UPnP
It is to establish the mapping relationship between the LAN and the WAN via the UPnP protocol.
Slight function differences may be found due to different series.
1.3 Specifications
Specifications
1.3.1 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
2
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
G711A, G711U , PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
Support TV/VGA video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per
channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Record and
playback
Support PAL/NTSC.
TV Adjust
Channel
Information
Hard disk
B
N/A
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Video:56-900MByte/h
Recording
Mode
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Storage
Mode
Support channel record quota setup
3
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Interface
Backup
Mode
Network
control
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback and
reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as motion detection and video loss via
client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Support network multiple-window preview function
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
N/A
N/A
4
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
SMART 1U case. 205(W) x205 (D) x41mm(H)
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
SMART 1U case.
270(W) x205 (D)
x41mm(H)
1.0-1.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.2 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
16-ch
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
5
Compression
Standard
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Video
Output
Video monitor
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
N/A
16-CH composite video input: (NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
Support TV/VGA video output at the same time.
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per
channel
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
1/2-ch: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
3-16-ch: CIF 352×288/ 352×240, QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Record and
H.264
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Channel
Information
Hard disk
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
N/A
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
6
playback
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Interface
Backup
Mode
Network
control
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback and
reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Support network multiple-window preview function
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
N/A
7
System
Information
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
SMART 1U case. 270(W) x205 (D) x41mm(H)
1.0-1.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.3 Enhanced 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
8
Compression
Standard
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U , PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output
Support TV/VGA /HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per
channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Hard disk
B
N/A
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Video:56-900MByte/h
9
Record and
playback
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Backup
Mode
Network
control
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback and
reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as motion detection and video loss via
client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Support network multiple-window preview function
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
10
Interface
System
Information
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
N/A
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
SMART 1U case. 205(W) x205 (D) x41mm(H)
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
SMART 1U case.
270(W) x205 (D)
x41mm(H)
1.0-1.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.4 Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
11
Compression
Standard
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
N/A
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC
(1.0VP- P, 75Ω)
composite video signal
output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output
Support TV/VGA
/HDMI video output at
the same time.
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Channel
Lock
Channel
Information
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output
Support VGA /HDMI video output at the same
time.
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per
channel
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-ch: 2CIF 704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/
352×240QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
12
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Hard disk
Record and
playback
N/A
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Backup
Mode
Network
control
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback and
reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Support network multiple-window preview function
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
N/A
13
Interface
System
Information
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M self-adaptable Ethernet port
N/A
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤15W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
≤25W (With adapter,
exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
SMART 1U case. 270(W) x205 (D) x41mm(H)
1.0-1.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation/wall mount installation
Desktop installation
1.3.5 General 2CIF Real-time Mini 1U Series
14
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control.
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
B
Support PAL(625 TVL 50fps) /NTSC(525 TVL 60fps)
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: 2CIF 704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
15
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
1-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
Reuse the first audio input channel.
Reuse audio output channel.
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
16
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Interface
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
System
Information
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
One USB 2.0 port.
One RJ45 10M/100M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤15W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
325(W) x242 (D) x55mm(H)
17
Weight
Installation
Mode
1.25KG KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.6 General Full-D1 Mini 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
B
Support PAL(625 TVL 50fps) /NTSC(525 TVL 60fps)
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-ch: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
18
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Hard disk
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Backup
Mode
Network
control
1-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
Reuse the first audio input channel.
Reuse audio output channel.
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support peripheral USB burner.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
19
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Interface
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
System
Information
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2 USB 2.0 ports.
One RJ45 10M/100M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤15W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
20
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
325(W) x242 (D) x55mm(H)
1.25KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.7 Enhanced 2CIF Real-time Mini 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control.
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
B
Support PAL(625 TVL 50fps) /NTSC(525 TVL 60fps)
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: 2CIF 704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
21
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
Reuse the first audio input channel.
Reuse audio output channel.
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
22
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
System
Information
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open
or normal close type to
select the alarm
type. )
3-channel relay output.
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open
or normal close type to
select the alarm
type. )
16-ch alarm input
(You can set normal
open or normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
30VDC 2A,125VAC 1A (Activation output)
One USB 2.0 port.
One RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
23
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
325(W) x242 (D) x55mm(H)
1.25KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.8 Enhanced Full-D1 Mini 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control.
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
B
Support PAL(625 TVL 50fps) /NTSC(525 TVL 60fps)
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per
channel
24
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Hard disk
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-ch: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
1/4/8/9 windows
TV Adjust
Channel
Information
Audio
1/4 windows(Optional)
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
Reuse the first audio input channel.
Reuse audio output channel.
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback and
reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
25
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
System
Information
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open
or normal close type to
select the alarm
type. )
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open
or normal close type to
select the alarm
type. )
16-ch alarm input
(You can set normal
open or normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output.
30VDC 2A,125VAC 1A (Activation output)
2 USB 2.0 ports.
One RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
N/A
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
26
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
325(W) x242 (D) x55mm(H)
1.25KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.9 Economic 2CIF Mini 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control.
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
27
Video Input
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
Video
Standard
Support PAL(625 TVL 50fps) /NTSC(525 TVL 60fps)
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Channel
Lock
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
B
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: 2CIF 704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
N/A
N/A
N/A
1 built-in SATA port. Support 1 HDD.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
28
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Interface
System
Information
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
Hard Disk
Information
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate screen message prompt.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2 USB 2.0 ports.
One RJ45 10M/100M self-adaptable Ethernet port
N/A
N/A
Display HDD current status
29
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤15W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
-10℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
325(W) x242 (D) x55mm(H)
1.25KG KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.10 General 1U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
30
Compression
Standard
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
H.264
G.711A
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
1/16-ch: D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Audio Input
Audio
Output
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
8-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
4-ch 2002000mv 10KΩ
(BNC)
1-ch audio output 2003000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 2003000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output
200-3000mv
5KΩ(RCA)
31
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard disk
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
1-ch audio talk output
200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output
200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk
output 2003000mv 5KΩ
(RCA)
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk and
etc.)
Support peripheral USB burner.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
32
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
16-ch alarm input
(You can set
normal open or
normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output.
30V DC 2A,125VAC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
33
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
1U standard industrial case. 375(W) x280 (D) x50mm(H)
1.5-2.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.11 960H 1U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
4-ch
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
Audio
Compression
G711A, G711U, PCM
Video monitor
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Privacy mask
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Video
Compression
Video Input
8-ch
4-CH composite
8-CH composite video 16-CH composite
video input:
input: (NTSC/PAL)
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
BNC (1.0VBP- P, B75Ω) (NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0VBP- P, B75Ω)
(1.0VBP- P, B75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
windows(Optional)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(700TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(700TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
960H 960 ×576/960×480
Playback channel 1/16:
960 ×576/960×480
D1 704×576/704×480 、CIF 352×288/ 352×240 、 QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
34
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuration
Audio
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Multi-channel
Playback
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Backup
function
Network
Function
Backup Mode
Network
control
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(RCA)
8-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(RCA)
4-ch 2002000mv 10KΩ
(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
35
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm Output
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
Support dual network cards mode such as multiple-address mode,
fault-tolerance, and load balance.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You
(You can set
can set normal open
can set normal open or
or normal close type to normal close type to
normal open or
select the alarm
normal close
select the alarm type. )
type to select the
type. )
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output.
30V DC 1A,125V AC 0.5A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
36
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
DC 12V
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
0℃-+55℃
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1U standard industrial case. 375(W) x280 (D) x50mm(H)
1.5-2.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.12 HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Video
Output
Video monitor
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
4-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A,G711U,PCM
4-CH HD-SDI video input: (NTSC/PAL) BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
720P/25, 720P/30, 720P/50, 720P/60, 1080P/25, 1080P/30, 1080i/50、
1080i/60
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
37
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Backup
PAL(50f/s),NTSC(60f/s)
Real time 1080P(1920*1080)
Recording playback 1/4- channel: 1080P 1920*1080, 720P 1280*720
D1 704×576/704×480 ; CIF 352×288/ 352×240;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
Dual-stream supported: Extra stream resolution:
D1 704×576/704×480 ;CIF 352×288/ 352×240 ;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
2 built-in SATA ports. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-3600MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4-channel playback mode.
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
38
function
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save.
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You can set normal open or normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
3-channel relay output.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
39
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1U standard industrial case. 375(W) x280 (D) x50mm(H)
1.5-2.5KG (Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.13 2HDD 1U Entry-level Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
4-ch
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
Audio
Compression
G711A, G711U, PCM
Video monitor
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Video
Compression
Video Input
8-ch
4-CH composite
8-CH composite video 16-CH composite
video input:
input: (NTSC/PAL)
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
BNC (1.0VBP- P, B75Ω) (NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0VBP- P, B75Ω)
(1.0VBP- P, B75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output
1-ch matrix output(Support multiple-window output mode)
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
40
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Privacy mask
Record and
playback
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuration
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Playback:
All-channel: D1 (704×576/704×480), HD1 (352×576/352×480), 2CIF
(704×288/704×240), CIF (52×288/ 352×240), QCIF
(176×144/176×120)
Image
Information
Channel
Information
Audio
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
windows(Optional)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(625TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(525TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
Storage Mode
Support channel record quota setup
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
41
Backup
function
Various File
Switch Ways
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel.
Playback Way
Support mark playback
Multi-channel
Playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Bidirectional audio.
Backup Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm Output
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You
(You can set
can set normal open
can set normal open or
or normal close type to normal close type to
normal open or
select the alarm
normal close
select the alarm type. )
type to select the
type. )
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
42
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1U standard industrial case. 375(W) x280 (D) x50mm(H)
1.5-2.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop installation
1.3.14 Full-D1 1.5U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
43
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
G.711A
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
1/16-ch: D1 704×576/704×480 , CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Hard disk
Support PAL/NTSC.
TV Adjust
Channel
Information
Audio
B
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
4-ch 200-2000mv
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
4 built-in SATA port. Support 4 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
44
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
16-ch alarm input
(You can set
normal open or
normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
45
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 75W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.15 HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series
Parameter
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
46
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G.711A
4-CH HD-SDI video
8-CH HD-SDI video
16-CH HD-SDI video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
input: (NTSC/PAL)
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
720P/25, 720P/30, 720P/50, 720P/60, 1080P/25, 1080P/30, 1080i/50、
1080i/60
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel
In non real-time mode:
and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s per channel
when the resolution of
the main stream is
1080P, the 1/5/9/13/channel max supports
25f/s or 30f/s and the
resolution of the rest
channels support 12f/s
or 15f/s.
1/4 windows
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9/16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(50f/s),NTSC(60f/s)
Real time 1080P(1920*1080)
Recording playback 1/4- channel: 1080P 1920*1080 720P 1280*720
D1 704×576/704×480 ; CIF 352×288/ 352×240;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
Dual-stream supported: Extra stream resolution:
D1 704×576/704×480 ;CIF 352×288/ 352×240 ;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
47
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
4-ch 200-2000mv
8-ch 200-2000mv
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
Channel
Information
Audio
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Backup
Mode
Network
control
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
4 built-in SATA ports. Support 4 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-3600MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4-channel
There is 1/4-channel
There is 1/4-channel
playback mode.
playback mode.
playback mode.
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
48
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You 16-ch alarm input
(You can set normal
can set normal open
can set normal open
or normal close type to or normal close type to open or normal close
select the alarm
select the alarm
type to select the
type. )
type. )
alarm type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
3 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
Two RS485 ports. PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
40W (Exclude HDD)
49
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG (Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.16 2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output(Support multiple-window output mode)
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
50
Playback:
All-channel: D1 704×576/704×480 , HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
51
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
16-ch alarm input
(You can set
normal open or
normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
52
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
3.5-4.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.17 4HDD Full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Special 16-ch
(Support 16channel loop)
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
53
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P,
75Ω)
16-CH
16-CH
composite video composite video
input:
input:
(NTSC/PAL)
(NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P,
BNC (1.0V P- P,
75Ω)
75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output(Support multiple-window output mode)
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
The special 16-channel product supports 16-channel loop output.
B
B
Video monitor
B
B
B
B
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows 1/4/8/9 /16
1/4/8/9 /16
windows(Option
windows
windows
al)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-channel: D1 704×576/704×480 , HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
8-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P,
75Ω)
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
4 built-in SATA port. Support 4 HDDs.
54
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA. Does not support disk array enclosure.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
55
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input 8-ch alarm input
(You can set
(You can set
normal open or
normal open or
normal close
normal close
type to select
type to select
the alarm
the alarm
type. )
type. )
3-channel relay output
16-ch alarm
input(You can
set normal open
or normal close
type to select
the alarm
type. )
16-ch alarm
input(You can
set normal open
or normal close
type to select
the alarm
type. )
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 75W)
≤25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
56
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.18 4/8/16-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
16-CH composite
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.(Support multiple-window display mode)
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
8-CH composite video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4 windows(Optional)
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
57
Playback:
1/2-ch: D1
704×576/704×480,
HD1
352×576/352×480,
2CIF
704×288/704×240,
CIF 352×288/
352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
Playback:
D1
704×576/704×480,
HD1
352×576/352×480,
2CIF
704×288/704×240,
CIF 352×288/
352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
Playback:
1/2-ch: D1
704×576/704×480,
HD1
352×576/352×480,
2CIF
704×288/704×240,
CIF 352×288/
352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
3/4-ch: 2CIF
3-8-ch: 2CIF
3-16-ch: 2CIF
704×288/704×240,
704×288/704×240,
704×288/704×240,
CIF 352×288/
CIF 352×288/
CIF 352×288/
352×240, QCIF
352×240, QCIF
352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
176×144/176×120
176×144/176×120
Note: When the main Note: When the main Note: When the main
stream is D1, the
stream is D1, the
stream is D1, the
extra stream can not extra stream can not extra stream can not
be 2CIF.
be 2CIF.
be 2CIF.
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
Reuse audio output channel
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
58
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
(You can set
normal open or
normal close
type to select the
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
4-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
30V DC
8-ch alarm input(You
can set normal open or
normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
59
Interface
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
3.5-4.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.19 24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
24-ch
32-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
60
Compression
Standard
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G.711A
24-CH composite video input:
32-CH composite video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
B
B
PAL (625 line, 50f/s), NTSC (525 line, 60f/s)
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
1/4/8/9 /16/25windows
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Playback:
Each channel supports: D1 704×576/704×480 , CIF 352×288/
352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Default resolution is 2CIF (25/30fps). Support D1and HD1(6/7fps)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
1/4/8/9 /16/25/36windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
B
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
61
Hard disk
Audio
Output
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:G711 27.5MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and backup
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
62
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input(You can set normal open or normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 75W)
35W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
63
1.3.20 2HDD CIF 1.5U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
24-ch
32-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
32-CH composite video input:
24-CH composite video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.(Support multiple-window display mode)
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
1/4/8/9/16/24 windows
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Playback:
All-ch:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
1/4/8/9 /16/25/32 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
All-ch:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution QCIF 176×144/176×120.
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
64
Channel
Lock
Channel
Information
Audio
Hard disk
Record and
playback
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Storage
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Playback
Way
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Network
Function
Backup
Mode
Network
control
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
Reuse audio output channel
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Support channel record quota setup
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Support mark playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
65
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
Power
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input(You can set normal open or normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
3-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 1A,125V AC 0.5A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
66
General
Parameter
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
3.5-4.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.21 Simple 1.5 U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
32-ch
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse,remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G711A, G711U, PCM
4-CH
8-CH
16-CH
24-CH
32-CH
composite
composite
composite
composite
composite
video input:
video input:
video input:
video input:
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) (NTSC/PAL) (NTSC/PAL) (NTSC/PAL) (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- BNC (1.0V P- BNC (1.0V P- BNC (1.0V P- BNC (1.0V PP, 75Ω)
P, 75Ω)
P, 75Ω)
P, 75Ω)
P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
Video
Output
24-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
B
Video monitor
16-ch
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9
1/4/8/9 /16
1/4/8/9 /16
1/4/8/9 /16
windows(Op windows
windows
/24windows /25/32windo
tional)
ws
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
67
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
TV Adjust
Channel
Information
Hard disk
Playback channel:
All-channel:
D1 704×576/704×480 ;
CIF 352×288/ 352×240;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
4-ch 2008-ch 2002000mv
2000mv
10KΩ(BNC) 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 2003000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
4-ch 2004-ch 200-2000mv
2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ (RCA)
1-ch audio
1-ch audio output 200output 200- 3000mv
3000mv
5KΩ(BNC)
5KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk output 2001-ch audio
1-ch audio output 2003000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
output 200- 3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
Reuse audio output
3000mv
Reuse audio output
channel.
10KΩ(RCA) channel.
Reuse audio
output
channel.
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
68
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm
8-ch alarm
input(You
input(You
can set
can set
normal open normal open
or normal
or normal
close type to close type to
select the
select the
alarm
alarm
type. )
type. )
3-channel relay output
16-ch alarm input(You can set normal
open or normal close type to select the
alarm type. )
30V DC 2A, 125V AC 0.5A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
69
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (Include adapter; Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
3.5-4.5KG (Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.22 960H 4HDD 1.5U Series
System
Parameter
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
Main
Processor
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
70
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
Video
Compression
H.264
Audio
Compression
G711A, G711U, PCM
Video Input
4-CH composite
8-CH composite video 16-CH composite
video input:
input: (NTSC/PAL)
video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
Video monitor
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Privacy mask
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
windows(Optional)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(700TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(700TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
960H 960 ×576/960×480
Playback channel 1/16:
960 ×576/960×480
D1 704×576/704×480 、CIF 352×288/ 352×240 、 QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuration
Audio
Audio Input
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
4-ch 2002000mv 10KΩ
(BNC)
71
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Multi-channel
Playback
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Backup
function
Backup Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
4 built-in SATA port. Support 4 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Support dual network cards mode such as multiple-address mode,
fault-tolerance, and load balance.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
72
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm Output
Interface
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You
(You can set
can set normal open
can set normal open or
or normal close type to normal close type to
normal open or
select the alarm
normal close
select the alarm type. )
type to select the
type. )
alarm type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output
port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.23 960H 2HDD 1.5U Series
73
System
Parameter
4-ch
Main
Processor
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input Devices
Embedded LINUX
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
8-ch
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
Video
Compression
H.264
Audio
Compression
G711A, G711U, PCM
Video Input
16-ch
8-CH composite video 16-CH composite
4-CH composite
input: (NTSC/PAL)
video input:
video input:
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
Video monitor
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Privacy mask
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
windows(Optional)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(700TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(700TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
960H 960 ×576/960×480
Playback channel 1/16:
960 ×576/960×480
D1 704×576/704×480, CIF 352×288/ 352×240, QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
74
Channel
Information
Color
Configuration
Audio
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Multi-channel
Playback
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Backup
function
Backup Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(RCA)
8-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(RCA)
4-ch 2002000mv 10KΩ
(RCA
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(RCA)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(RCA)
2 built-in SATA port. Support 2 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Support dual network cards mode such as multiple-address mode,
fault-tolerance, and load balance.
75
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm Output
Interface
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You
(You can set
can set normal open
can set normal open or
or normal close type to normal close type to
normal open or
select the alarm
normal close
select the alarm type. )
type to select the
type. )
alarm type. )
3-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output
port.
30V DC 1A,125V AC 0.5A(activation alarm )
2 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
DC 12V
≤25W (With adapter, exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
76
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
1.5U standard industrial case. 440(W) x410 (D) x70mm(H)
4.5-5.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.24 General 2U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
4-ch
8-ch
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
Audio
Compression
G.711A
4-CH
8-CH
16-CH
24H
32H
composite
composite
composite
composite
composite
video input: video input: video input: video input: video input:
(NTSC/PAL (NTSC/PAL (NTSC/PAL (NTSC/PAL (NTSC/PAL
) BNC
) BNC
) BNC
) BNC
) BNC
(1.0V P- P,
(1.0V P- P,
(1.0V P- P,
(1.0V P- P,
(1.0V P- P,
75Ω)
75Ω)
75Ω)
75Ω)
75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
32-ch
Embedded LINUX
H.264
Video monitor
24-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Video
Compression
Video Input
16-ch
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9
1/4/8/9 /16
1/4/8/9
1/4/8/9
windows(O
windows
windows
/16/25
/16/25/36
ptional)
windows
windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback channel 1/16:
D1 704×576/704×480
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
77
Image Quality
Privacy mask
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuration
Audio
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Multi-channel
Playback
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Backup
function
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Backup Mode
4-channel
8-channel
16-channel
16-channel
2002002002002000mV
2000mV
2000mV
2000mV
10KΩ
10KΩ
10KΩ
10KΩ
(BNC)
(BNC)
(BNC)
(BNC)
1-channel audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
16-channel
2002000mV
10KΩ
(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
8 built-in SATA port. Support 8 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
78
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm Output
Interface
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm
8-ch alarm
16-ch alarm 16-ch alarm 16-ch alarm
input(You
input(You
input(You
input(You
input(You
can set
can set
can set
can set
can set
normal
normal
normal
normal
normal
open or
open or
open or
open or
open or
normal
normal
normal
normal
normal
close type
close type
close type
close type
close type
to select the to select the to select the to select the to select the
alarm
alarm
alarm
alarm
alarm
type. )
type. )
type. )
type. )
type. )
6-channel
6-channel
6-channel
5-channel
5-channel
relay
relay
relay
relay
relay
output,
output,
output,
output.,
output,
including
including
including
including
including
one
one
one
one
one
controllable controllable controllable controllable controllable
DC +12V
DC +12V
DC +12V
DC +12V
DC +12V
output port. output port. output port. output port. output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
3 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
79
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
2U standard industrial case. 440(W) x460 (D) x89mm(H)
6.5-7.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.25 HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G.711A
4-CH HD-SDI video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
8-CH HD-SDI video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
16-CH HD-SDI video
input: (NTSC/PAL)
BNC (0.8VP-P,75Ω)
80
Video monitor
Video
Output
Video
Standard
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Record and
playback
Real time 1080P(1920*1080)
Recording playback channel1/4: 1080P 1920*1080 720P 1280*720
D1 704×576/704×480 ; CIF 352×288/ 352×240;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
Dual-stream supported: Extra stream resolution:
D1 704×576/704×480 ;CIF 352×288/ 352×240 ;
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
4-ch 200-2000mv
8-ch 200-2000mv
16-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ(BNC)
10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Hard disk
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
Channel
Information
Audio
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
720P/25, 720P/30, 720P/50, 720P/60, 1080P/25, 1080P/30, 1080i/50、
1080i/60
Real-time Mode: PAL
Real-time Mode: PAL
In non real-time mode:
1f/s to 25f/s per
1f/s to 25f/s per
when the resolution of
channel and NTSC
channel and NTSC
the main stream is
1f/s to 30f/s per
1f/s to 30f/s per
1080P, the 1/5/9/13/channel
channel
channel max supports
25f/s or 30f/s and the
resolution of the rest
channels support 12f/s
or 15f/s.
1/4 windows
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9/16 windows
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Recording
Length
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
8 built-in SATA port. Support 8 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-3600MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
81
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4-channel
There is 1/4-channel
There is 1/4-channel
playback mode.
playback mode.
playback mode.
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You 16-ch alarm input
(You can set normal
can set normal open
can set normal open
or normal close type to or normal close type to open or normal close
select the alarm
select the alarm
type to select the
alarm type. )
type. )
type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
4 USB 2.0 ports.
82
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Manageme
nt
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
Two RS485 ports. PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
50W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
2U standard industrial case. 440(W) x460 (D) x89mm(H)
7.0-8.0KG (Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.26 960H 2U Series
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
4-ch
8-ch
16-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
83
Interface
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
Video
Compression
H.264
Audio
Compression
G.711A
Video Input
8-CH composite video 16-CH composite
4-CH composite
input: (NTSC/PAL)
video input:
video input:
BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(NTSC/PAL) BNC
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
(1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
B
B
Video monitor
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Privacy mask
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9 windows
1/4/8/9 /16 windows
windows(Optional)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(700TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(700TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
960H 960 ×576/960×480
Playback channel 1/16:
960 ×576/960×480
D1 704×576/704×480 、CIF 352×288/ 352×240 、 QCIF
176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Color
Configuration
84
Audio
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Multi-channel
Playback
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Backup
function
Backup Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
4-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
8-ch 200-2000mv
10KΩ(BNC)
16-ch 2002000mv 10KΩ
(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
8 built-in SATA port. Support 8 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
85
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Alarm Output
Interface
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input
4-ch alarm input(You 8-ch alarm input(You
(You can set
can set normal open
can set normal open or
or normal close type to normal close type to
normal open or
select the alarm
normal close
select the alarm type. )
type to select the
type. )
alarm type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output
port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 0.5A(activation alarm )
3 USB 2.0 ports.
2 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
2U standard industrial case. 440(W) x460 (D) x89mm(H)
6.5-7.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
86
1.3.27 8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series
4-ch
Parameter
System
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input Devices
Input Method
Shortcut
Function
Compression
Standard
8-ch
Special 16-ch
(Support 16channel loop
output)
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel
playback and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double
click USB mouse to switch screen.
Video
Compression
H.264
Audio
Compression
G711A, G711U, PCM
Video Input
4-CH
8-CH
16-CH
16-CH
composite
composite
composite
composite
video input:
video input:
video input:
video input:
(NTSC/PAL)
(NTSC/PAL)
(NTSC/PAL)
(NTSC/PAL)
BNC (1.0V P- P,
BNC (1.0V P- P,
BNC (1.0V P- P,
BNC (1.0V P- P,
75Ω)
75Ω)
75Ω)
75Ω)
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
1-ch matrix output (Support multiple-window output mode).
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
The special 16-channel product supports 16-channel loop output.
B
Video monitor
B
Video Output
Video
Standard
Record Speed
Video Partition
Monitor
Touring
16-ch
B
B
B
B
B
B
Support PAL/NTSC.
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4
1/4/8/9
1/4/8/9 /16
1/4/8/9 /16
windows(Optio
windows
windows
windows
nal)
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
PAL(625TVL, 50f/s)/NTSC(525TVL, 60f/s)
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC)
Image Quality
Playback :
All-channel
D1 704×576/704×480, HD1 352×576/352×480, 2CIF
704×288/704×240, CIF 352×288/ 352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Support dual streams.
Extra stream resolution:
CIF 352×288/ 352×240
QCIF 176×144/176×120
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
87
Privacy mask
Image
Information
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
Color
Configuration
Audio Input
Audio Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Recording
Mode
Record and
playback
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
4-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
8 built-in SATA port. Support 8 HDDs.
Audio:PCM 28.8MByte/h
Video:56-900MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
Storage Mode
Support channel record quota setup
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat Way
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
Record Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch Ways
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
Playback Way
Support mark playback
Multi-channel
Playback
There is 1/4/9/16-channel playback mode.
(It may vary due to different series.)
Window Zoom
Partial
Enlargement
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any
zone to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk,
USB burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA. Does not support disk array enclosure.
Backup
function
Backup Mode
Network
control
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Support network download and save
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
88
Network
Function
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Support network multiple-window preview function
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External Alarm
Manual Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm Output
Alarm Relay
USB Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data Stream
Statistics
Log statistics
Version
On-line user
User
Management
User
Management
Password
Authentication
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message
prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm
16-ch alarm
4-ch alarm
8-ch alarm
input(You can input(You can input(You can input(You can
set normal
set normal
set normal
set normal
open or normal open or normal open or normal open or normal
close type to
close type to
close type to
close type to
select the alarm select the alarm select the alarm select the alarm
type. )
type. )
type. )
type. )
3-channel relay output
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
4 USB 2.0 ports.
1 RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network
user.
Configurable user power.
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
89
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumption
Working
Temperature
Working
Humidity
Air Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options:
Logout /shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 150W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
2U standard industrial case. 440(W) x460 (D) x89mm(H)
6.5-7.5KG(Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
1.3.28 24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series
Parameter
System
Compression
Standard
Main
Processor
OS
System
Resources
Interface
Input
Devices
Input
Method
Shortcut
Function
Video
Compressio
n
Audio
Compressio
n
Video Input
Video monitor
24-ch
32-ch
High-performance industrial embedded micro controller
Embedded LINUX
Multiplex operations: Multiple-channel record, multiple-channel playback
and network operation simultaneously
User-friendly graphical user interface
Front panel, USB mouse, remote control
Arabic number, English character, donation and extension Chinese
(optional)
Copy/paste operation, USB mouse right-key shortcut menu, double click
USB mouse to switch screen.
H.264
G.711A
24-CH composite video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
32-CH composite video input:
(NTSC/PAL) BNC (1.0V P- P, 75Ω)
B
B
Video
Output
1-ch PAL/NTSC, BNC (1.0VP- P, 75Ω) composite video signal output.
1-ch VGA output.
1-ch HDMI output.
Support TV/VGA/HDMI video output at the same time.
Video
Standard
PAL (50f/s), NTSC (60f/s)
Record
Speed
Video
Partition
Monitor
Touring
Real-time Mode: PAL 1f/s to 25f/s per channel and NTSC 1f/s to 30f/s
per channel
1/4/8/9/16/25 windows
1/4/8/9/16/25/36 windows
Support monitor tour functions such as alarm, motion detection, and
schedule auto control.
90
Resolution
(PAL/NTSC
)
Image
Quality
Privacy
mask
Image
Information
6-level image quality (Adjustable)
TV Adjust
Adjust TV output zone suitable to anamorphic video.
Channel
Lock
Cover secret channel with black screen though system is encoding
normally.
Screen-lock function to prevent unauthorized user seeing secret video.
Channel name, recording status, screen lock status, video loss status
and motion detection status are shown on the bottom left of display
screen.
Hue, brightness, contrast, saturation and gain setup for each channel.
Channel
Information
Audio
Color
Configuratio
n
Audio Input
Audio
Output
Hard disk
Bidirectional
Audio
Hard Disk
Hard Disk
Occupation
Record and
playback
PAL/NTSC
Real-time monitor:
D1 704×576/704×480
Playback:
Each channel supports:: D1 704×576/704×480 , CIF 352×288/
352×240 , QCIF 176×144/176×120
Default resolution is 2CIF (25/30fps). Support D1and HD1(6/7fps)
Support dual streams: extra stream resolution CIF 352×288/ 352×240,
QCIF 176×144/176×120.
Recording
Mode
Recording
Length
Playback
Repeat
Way
Record
Search
Playback
Mode
Various File
Switch
Ways
Multichannel
Playback
Support one privacy mask of user-defined size in full screen.
Support max 4 zones.
Channel information, time information and privacy mask zone.
16-ch 200-2000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk input 200-3000mv 10KΩ(BNC)
1-ch audio talk output 200-3000mv 5KΩ(BNC)
8 built-in SATA port. Support 8 HDDs.
Audio:G711 27.5MByte/h
Video:56-3600MByte/h
Manual recording, motion detection recording, schedule recording and
alarm recording
Priority: Manual recording> alarm recording>motion detection
recording>schedule recording.
1 to 120 minutes single record duration (Default setup is 60 minutes)
When hard disk is full, system can overwrite previous video file.
Various search engines such as time, type and channel.
Various fast play, slow play speeds, manual frame by frame playback
and reverse play mode.
Can switch to previous or next file or any file in current play list.
Can switch to file on other channel of the same time. (If there is a file)
Support file continuous play, when a file is end system auto plays the
next file in the current channel
There is 1/4/-channel playback mode.
91
Window
Zoom
Partial
Enlargemen
t
Backup
function
Backup
Mode
Network
Function
Network
control
Motion
Detection and
Alarm
Motion
Detection
Video Loss
External
Alarm
Manual
Alarm
Control
Alarm Input
Interface
Alarm
Output
Alarm Relay
USB
Interface
Network
connection
RS485
RS232
System
Information
Hard Disk
Information
Data
Stream
Statistics
Log
statistics
Version
User
Management
On-line user
User
Manageme
nt
Switch between self-adaptive screen/full screen when playback
When in one-window full-screen playback mode, you can select any zone
to activate partial enlargement function.
HDD backup
Support peripheral USB backup device. (Flash disk, portable disk, USB
burner and etc.)
Support peripheral eSATA backup device.
Support network download and backup
View monitor channel remotely.
DVR configuration through client-end and web browser
Upgrade via client or browser to realize remote maintenance.
View alarm information such as external alarm, motion detection and
video loss via client.
Support network PTZ lens control
File download backup and playback
Multiple devices share information via corresponding software such as
professional surveillance software (PSS)
Duplex transparent COM
Network alarm input and output
Bidirectional audio.
Zone setup: support 396/330((PAL 22×18, NTSC 22×15)) detection
zones.
Various sensitivity levels.
Alarm can activate record or external alarm or screen message prompt.
Alarm can activate external alarm or screen message prompt.
Support record activation function or activate external alarm or screen
message in specified period.
Enable or disable alarm input channel
Support analog alarm signal to specific alarm output channel.
16-ch alarm input(You can set normal open or normal close type to
select the alarm type. )
6-channel relay output, including one controllable DC +12V output port.
30V DC 2A,125V AC 1A(activation alarm )
3 USB 2.0 ports.
RJ45 10M/100M/1000M self-adaptable Ethernet port
PTZ control port
Support various PTZ control protocols.
Ordinary COM (Debug),keyboard connection and transparent serial
port(COM input and output via network )
Display HDD current status
Data stream statistics for each channel (in wave mode)
Backup to 1024 log files.
Support various search engines such as time and type.
Display version information: channel amount, alarm input and output
amount, system version and release date.
Display current on-line user
Multi-lever user management; various management modes
Integrated management for local user, serial port user and network user.
Configurable user power.
92
Password
Authenticati
on
Upgrade
Login, Logout and Shutdown
General
Parameter
Power
Power
Consumptio
n
Working
Temperatur
e
Working
Humidity
Air
Pressure
Dimension
Weight
Installation
Mode
Support user /group and its corresponding rights modification.
No limit to the user or group amount.
Password modification
Administrator can modify other user’s password.
Account lock strategy
Five times login failure in thirty minutes may result in account lock.
Web browser, client-end and update tool.
Password login protection to guarantee safety
User-friendly interface when login. Provide the following options: Logout
/shutdown/ restart.
Right authentication when shut down to make sure only those proper
people can turn off DVR
AC90~264V 50+2% Hz (Max 220W)
25W (Exclude HDD)
0℃-+55℃
10%-90%
86kpa-106kpa
2U standard industrial case. 440(W) x460 (D) x89mm(H)
6.5-7.5KG (Exclude HDD)
Desktop/rack installation
93
2 Overview and Controls
This section provides information about front panel and rear panel. When you install this series
DVR for the first time, please refer to this part first.
2.1 Front Panel
2.1.1 4/8-Channel Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
The front panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-2.
Figure 2-1
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
Function
1
HDD status indictor light
The red light becomes on when HDD is abnormal.
2
Power indicator light
The red light becomes on when the power
connection is OK.
3
Network status indicator
light
The red light becomes on when the network
connection is abnormal.
2.1.2 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U/1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series /Enhanced 1HDD
Full-D1 Smart 1U/16-Channel Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
The front panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-2.
Figure 2-2
94
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
Function
1
Network status indicator
light
The red light becomes on when the network
connection is abnormal.
2
Power indicator light
The red light becomes on when the power
connection is OK.
3
HDD status indictor light
The red light becomes on when HDD is abnormal.
4
USB
USB port
2.1.3 4/8-Channel General 2CIF Mini 1U/ 4/8-Channel Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U
The front panel is shown as in Figure 2-3.
Figure 2-3
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up
or shut down DVR.
Power button
Up/
Down
Function
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up
and down.
、
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
Shift current activated control,
Left/
Right
⊳
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
ESC
ESC
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
Assistant
Fn
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display
assistant function: PTZ control and image color.
95
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press
it for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction
keys to realize setup.
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
Realize other special functions.
USB port
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
Network
abnormal
indication
light
Net
Network error occurs or there is no network connection, the
light becomes red to alert you.
HDD
abnormal
indication
light
HDD
HDD error occurs or HDD capacity is below specified
threshold value, the light becomes red to alert you.
IR Receiver
IR
Alarm
indication
light
Alarm
It is to receive the signal from the remote control.
Here you can view there is external alarm input or not. The
light becomes on when there is an external alarm. The light
become off when the external alarm stops.
2.1.4 16-Channel General 2CIF Mini 1U/ 16-Channel Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U
The front panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-4.
Figure 2-4
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up
or shut down DVR.
Power button
Up
Down
Function
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up
and down.
、
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
96
Shift current activated control,
Left
Right
⊳
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar..
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
ESC
ESC
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
Slow play
Assistant
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
Fn
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display
assistant function: PTZ control and image color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press
it for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction
keys to realize setup.
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
Realize other special functions.
USB port
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
Network
abnormal
indication
light
Net
Network error occurs or there is no network connection, the
light becomes red to alert you.
HDD
abnormal
indication
light
HDD
HDD error occurs or HDD capacity is below specified
threshold value, the light becomes red to alert you.
IR Receiver
IR
It is to receive the signal from the remote control.
2.1.5 Economic 2CIF Mini 1U
The front panel is shown as in Figure 2-5.
97
Figure 2-5
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Icon
Name
Function
1
Network
status
indication light
Power status indication
light
HDD status indication
light
2
3
The red light becomes on when the network
connection is not proper.
The red light is on when the power
connection is proper.
The red light is on when the HDD
malfunction occurred.
2.1.6 General 1U Series
The front panel is shown as in Figure 2-6.
Figure 2-6
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Function
Power button
Power button, press this button for three seconds to
boot up or shut down DVR.
Number button
Number 0-9 and
etc
Shift
Fast play
In textbox, click this button to switch between
numeral, English (Small/Capitalized), donation and
etc.
Enable or disable tour.
Various fast speeds and normal playback.
Slow play
Play/Pause
Input Arabic number
Switch channel
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
In backward playback or pause mode, click this
button to go normal playback.
In normal playback click this button to pause
playback
In pause mode, click this button to resume
playback.
In
real-time
monitor
click itclick
to this
go to
the
In normal
playback
or mode,
pause mode,
button
⊳
Play previous
to reverse
playback
In reverse playback, click this button to pause
playback.
In playback
mode, playback the previous video
Play Next
In playback mode, playback the next video
Activate current control, modify setup, and then
move up and down.
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
Reverse/Pause
Up/Down
,
98
Left/Right
,
ESC
ESC
Enter
ENTER
Assistant
Fn
Record
REC
Window switch
Mult
USB port
Shift current activated control, and then move left
and right.
When playback, click these buttons to control
playback bar.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor
mode.
Confirm current operation
Go to default button
Go to menu
One-window monitor mode, click this button to
display assistant function: PTZ control and image
color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text
control, press it for 1.5 seconds to delete the
previous character before the cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and
direction keys to realize setup.
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral,
English character(small/capitalized) and etc.
In HDD management interface, you can click it to
switch HDD record information and other
information (Menu prompt)
Realize other special functions.
Manually stop/start recording, working with direction
keys
or numeral keys to select the recording channel.
Click it to switch one-window/multiple-window.
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse, burner
and etc.
Record light
1-16
Power
light
Power
indication
For 4/8/16 channel device: indication light on means
that the channel is in recording.
Power indication light.
HDD
abnormal
indication light
HDD
HDD error occurs or HDD capacity is below specified
threshold value, the light becomes red to alert you.
Network abnormal
indication light
Net
Network error occurs or there is no network connection,
the light becomes red to alert you.
IR Receiver
IR
It is to receive the signal from the remote control.
2.1.7 960H 1U Series /2HDD 1U Entry-level Series/ HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series
The front panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-7.
Figure 2-7
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Function
99
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up
or shut down DVR.
Power button
Shift
Shift
In textbox, click this button to switch between numeral,
English(Small/Capitalized),donation and etc.
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up
and down.
Up/1
Down/4
、
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
In text mode, input number 1/4 (English character G/H/I)
Shift current activated control,
Left/2
Right/3
⊳
ESC
ESC
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar.
In text mode, input number 2(English character A/B/C)
/3(English character D/E/F)
.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
Record
REC
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
In text mode, input number 8 (English character T/U/V).
Slow play/8
Assistant
Manually stop/start recording, working with direction keys
or numeral keys to select the recording channel.
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display
assistant function: PTZ control and image color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press
it for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction
keys to realize setup.
Fn
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
Realize other special functions.
Fast play/7
Various fast speeds and normal playback.
In text mode, input number 7 (English character P/Q/R/S).
Play
previous/0
In playback mode, playback the previous video
In text mode, input number 0.
Reverse/Pau
se/6
In normal playback or pause mode, click this button to
reverse
playback
In reverse playback, click this button to pause playback.
In text mode, input number 6 (English character M/N/O)
.
⊳
100
Play Next/9
Play/Pause /5
USB port
In playback mode, playback the next video
In menu setup, go to down ward of the dropdown list.
In text mode, input number 9 (English character W/X/Y/Z)
.
In normal playback click this button to pause playback
In pause mode, click this button to resume playback.
In text mode, input number 5(English character J/K/L).
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
Network
abnormal
indication
light
Net
Network error occurs or there is no network connection, the
light becomes red to alert you.
HDD
abnormal
indication
light
HDD
HDD error occurs or HDD capacity is below specified
threshold value, the light becomes red to alert you.
Record light
1-16
IR Receiver
IR
System is recording or not. It becomes on when system is
recording.
It is to receive the signal from the remote control.
2.1.8 Full-D1 1.5U and Simple 1.5U Series
The front panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-8.
Figure 2-8
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up
or shut down DVR.
Power button
Shift
Function
Shift
In textbox, click this button to switch between numeral,
English(Small/Capitalized),donation and etc.
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up
and down.
Up/1
Down/4
、
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
In text mode, input number 1/4 (English character G/H/I)
Left/2
Right/3
⊳
Shift current activated control,
101
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar.
In text mode, input number 2(English character A/B/C)
/3(English character D/E/F)
.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
ESC
ESC
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
Record
REC
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
In text mode, input number 8 (English character T/U/V).
Slow play/8
Assistant
Manually stop/start recording, working with direction keys
or numeral keys to select the recording channel.
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display
assistant function: PTZ control and image color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press
it for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction
keys to realize setup.
Fn
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
Realize other special functions.
Fast play/7
Various fast speeds and normal playback.
In text mode, input number 7 (English character P/Q/R/S).
Play
previous/0
Reverse/Pau
se/6
In playback mode, playback the previous video
In text mode, input number 0.
⊳
Play Next/9
Play/Pause /5
USB port
Remote control
indication light
In normal playback or pause mode, click this button to
reverse
playback
In reverse playback, click this button to pause playback.
In text mode, input number 6 (English character M/N/O)
. playback mode, playback the next video
In
In menu setup, go to down ward of the dropdown list.
In text mode, input number 9 (English character W/X/Y/Z)
.
In normal playback click this button to pause playback
In pause mode, click this button to resume playback.
In text mode, input number 5(English character J/K/L).
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
ACT
Remote control indication light
102
Status indication
light
Status
If there is Fn indication light, current status indication light is null.
Power indication
light
Power
Power indication light
Record light
1-16
It becomes on when system is recording.
2.1.9 HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series/960H 1.5U Series/2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry(4/8/16/24/32level Series/4HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series/(
channel)
)2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/2HDD CIF 1.5U Series
The front panel is shown as in Figure 2-9.
Figure 2-9
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up
or shut down DVR.
Power button
Shift
Function
Shift
In textbox, click this button to switch between numeral,
English(Small/Capitalized),donation and etc.
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up
and down.
Up/1
Down/4
、
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
In text mode, input number 1/4 (English character G/H/I)
Shift current activated control,
Left/2
Right/3
⊳
ESC
ESC
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar.
In text mode, input number 2(English character A/B/C)
/3(English character D/E/F)
.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
103
Record
REC
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
In text mode, input number 8 (English character T/U/V).
Slow play/8
Assistant
Manually stop/start recording, working with direction keys
or numeral keys to select the recording channel.
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display
assistant function: PTZ control and image color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press
it for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction
keys to realize setup.
Fn
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
Realize other special functions.
Fast play/7
Various fast speeds and normal playback.
In text mode, input number 7 (English character P/Q/R/S).
Play
previous/0
Reverse/Pau
se/6
In playback mode, playback the previous video
In text mode, input number 0.
⊳
Play Next/9
Play/Pause /5
USB port
In normal playback or pause mode, click this button to
reverse
playback
In reverse playback, click this button to pause playback.
In text mode, input number 6 (English character M/N/O)
. playback mode, playback the next video
In
In menu setup, go to down ward of the dropdown list.
In text mode, input number 9 (English character W/X/Y/Z)
.
In normal playback click this button to pause playback
In pause mode, click this button to resume playback.
In text mode, input number 5(English character J/K/L).
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
Network
abnormal
indication
light
Net
Network error occurs or there is no network connection, the
light becomes red to alert you.
HDD
abnormal
indication
light
HDD
HDD error occurs or HDD capacity is below specified
threshold value, the light becomes red to alert you.
Record light
1-16
System is recording or not. It becomes on when system is
recording.
2.1.10 General 2U Series/960H Series/ HD-SDI Series/8HDD Full-D1 2U Entrylevel Series / 24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series
The Front panel is shown as follows. See Figure 2-10.
104
Figure 2-10
Please refer to the following sheet for front panel button information.
Name
Icon
Function
Power button, press this button for three seconds to boot up or
shut down DVR.
Power button
Number button
0-9
Input Arabic number
Switch channel
Input number
more than 10
-/--
If you want to input a number more than 10, please click this
button and then input.
Shift
Up/
Down
、
In textbox, click this button to switch between numeral,
English(Small/Capitalized),donation and etc.
Enable or disable tour.
Activate current control, modify setup, and then move up and
down.
Increase/decrease numeral.
Assistant function such as PTZ menu.
Left/
Right
Shift current activated control, and then move left and right.
⊳
When playback, click these buttons to control playback bar.
Go to previous menu, or cancel current operation.
ESC
ESC
When playback, click it to restore real-time monitor mode.
Confirm current operation
Enter
ENTER
Go to default button
Go to menu
Record
REC
Manually stop/start recording, working with direction keys
or numeral keys to select the recording channel.
Slow play
Multiple slow play speeds or normal playback.
Assistant
One-window monitor mode, click this button to display assistant
function: PTZ control and image color.
Backspace function: in numeral control or text control, press it
for 1.5seconds to delete the previous character before the
cursor.
Fn
105
In motion detection setup, working with Fn and direction keys to
realize setup.
In text mode, click it to switch between numeral, English
character(small/capitalized) and etc.
In HDD management interface, you can click it to switch HDD
record information and other information (Menu prompt)
Realize other special functions.
Fast play
Various fast speeds and normal playback.
Play previous
Reverse/Pause
In playback mode, playback the previous video
⊳
Play Next
In normal playback or pause mode, click this button to reverse
playback
In reverse playback, click this button to pause playback.
In playback mode, playback the next video
In menu setup, go to down ward of the dropdown list.
Play/Pause
In normal playback click this button to pause playback
In pause mode, click this button to resume playback.
Window switch
Mult
Click it to switch one-window/multiple-window.
In real-time monitor mode it works as left/right direction key.
Playback mode, counter clockwise to forward and clock wise to
backward.
Up/down direction key.
Playback mode, turn the inner dial to realized frame by frame
playback. (Only applies to some special versions.)
Shuttle(outer
ring)
Jog(inner dial)
USB port
To connect USB storage device, USB mouse.
Remote control
indication light
ACT
Remote control indication light
Status indication
light
Status
The light is on if device operates properly.
Power indication
light
PWR
Power indication light
Record light
1-32
It becomes on when system is recording.
2.2 Rear Panel
106
2.2.1 General 2CIF Mini 1U Series
The 4-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-11.
Figure 2-11
The 8-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-12.
Figure 2-12
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-13.
Figure 2-13
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio output
4
Audio input
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
On/off button
12
GND port
107
2.2.2 Enhanced 2CIF Mini 1U Series
The 4-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-20.
Figure 2-14
The 8-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-20.
Figure 2-15
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Audio input
3
Audio output
4
Video output
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
On/off button
12
Alarm input/alarm output
13
GND port
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-22.
Figure 2-16
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
108
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Audio input
Audio output
Video output
Alarm input/alarm output
Video VGA output
HDMI port
USB port
Network port
RS-485 port
Power socket
On/off button
GND port
2.2.3 General Mini 1U Series
The 4-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-17.
Figure 2-17
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio output
4
Audio input
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
On/off button
12
GND port
The 8-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-18.
Figure 2-18
109
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio output
4
Audio input
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
On/off button
12
GND port
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-19.
Figure 2-19
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio output
4
Audio input
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
On/off button
12
GND port
2.2.4 Enhanced Mini 1U Series
The 4-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-20.
Figure 2-20
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
110
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Video input
Video output
Video VGA output
HDMI port
USB port
Network port
RS-485 port
Power socket
Alarm input/alarm output
GND port
Audio output
Audio input
On/off button
The 8-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-21.
Figure 2-21
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Audio input
3
Audio output
4
Video output
5
Video VGA output
6
HDMI port
7
USB port
8
Network port
9
RS-485 port
10
Power socket
11
Alarm input/alarm output
12
On/off button
13
GND port
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-22.
Figure 2-22
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
111
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Audio input
Audio output
Video output
Alarm input/alarm output
Video VGA output
HDMI port
USB port
Network port
RS-485 port
Power socket
On/off button
GND port
2.2.5 Economic 2CIF mini 1U Series
The 4/8/16-channel economic 2CIF mini 1U series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure
2-23 through Figure 2-25.
Figure 2-23
Figure 2-24
112
Figure 2-25
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
USB port
3
HDMI Port
4
Network port
5
Power socket
6
Video VGA output port
7
GND port
8
On/off button
2.2.6 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series /1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
Here we take 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U as an example. See Figure 2-26 through Figure 2-28.
Figure 2-26
Figure 2-27
113
Figure 2-28
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
SN
Name
1
Video input
2
Video output
4
USB port
7
GND port
5
Network port
SN
3
Name
VGA output
6
Power socket
2.2.7 Enhanced 1HDD 2CIF Smart 1U Series
The 4/8-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-31 through Figure 2-33.
Figure 2-29
Figure 2-30
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
SN
Name
1
Video input
2
USB port
SN
3
Name
Video VGA output
114
4
GND port
7
Power socket
5
HDMI port
6
Network port
2.2.8 Enhanced 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U Series
The 4/8/16-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-31 through Figure
2-33.
Figure 2-31
Figure 2-32
Figure 2-33
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
SN
Name
1
Video input
2
Video output
4
USB port
5
HDMI port
7
Power socket
8
GND port
SN
3
Name
VGA output
6
Network port
2.2.9 General 1U Series
The 4/8-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-34.
115
Figure 2-34
The 16-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-35.
Figure 2-35
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Audio input
3
Video spot output
4
Video CVBS output
5
Bidirectional talk input
6
Audio output
7
Network port
8
USB port
9
HDMI port
10
Video VGA output
11
RS232 port
12
Alarm input/alarm output/RS485 port
13
Power socket
14
GND port
15
On/off button
2.2.10 960H 1U Series
The 8-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-36.
Figure 2-36
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
116
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Video input
Video output
Audio input
Audio output
RS232 port
Alarm input/alarm output
Video SPOT output
Bidirectional talk input
Video VGA output
HDMI port
USB port
Network port
RS485 port
Power input port
Power button
GND port
2.2.11 HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series
The 16-channel rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-37.
Figure 2-37
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Audio output
2
Bidirectional talk output port
3
RS232 port
4
Video input
5
Audio input
6
Video output
7
Bidirectional talk input port
8
Video VGA output
9
Network port
10
HDMI port
11
eSATA port
12
USB port
13
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
14
Power input port
15
Power button
2.2.12 2HDD 1U Entry-level Series
The 4-channel rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-38.
117
Figure 2-38
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Video SPOT output
4
Audio input
5
Audio output
6
Bidirectional talk input
7
RS232 port
8
Video VGA output
9
Alarm input/alarm output
10
HDMI port
11
USB port
12
Network port
13
RS485 port
14
Power input port
15
Power button
2.2.13 Full-D1 1.5U Series
The rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-39.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
Figure 2-39
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Power button
4
Fan
5
Audio input /Matrix video output/Loop video
output
6
Video input
7
Video CVBS output
8
Bidirectional talk input port
9
Bidirectional talk output port
10
Audio output
118
11
12
13
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
Video VGA output
HDMI port
14
15
16
17
RS232 port
eSATA port
USB port
Network port
2.2.14 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/Simple 1.5U Series
The following figure is based on the 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U 16-channel series product. See Figure
2-40.
Figure 2-40
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Video SPOT output
4
Audio input
5
Audio output
6
Bidirectional talk input
7
RS-232 port
8
Video VGA output
9
HDMI port
10
USB port
11
Network port
12
RS-485 port
13
Power socket
14
Alarm input/alarm output
15
Power on-off button
2.2.15 2HDD CIF 1.5U Series/24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U
The rear panel of 16-channel series product is shown as in Figure 2-41.
Figure 2-41
119
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio input
4
Alarm input/alarm output
5
Power on-off button
6
GND port
7
Power socket
8
Bidirectional talk input
9
Video SPOT output
10
USB port
11
Network port
12
Video VGA output
13
RS-232 port
2.2.16 HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series
The rear panel of 4/8-channel series product is shown as in Figure 2-42.
Figure 2-42
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Video input
4
Bidirectional talk input port
5
Video output
6
Network port
7
Video VGA output
8
RS232 port
9
HDMI port
10
eSATA port
11
USB port
12
Power button
13
Fan
14
15
16
17
Audio input
Bidirectional talk output port
Audio output
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
The rear panel of the 16-channel series product is shown as in Figure 2-43.
120
Figure 2-43
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Video input
4
Network port
5
Video VGA output
6
RS232 port
7
HDMI port
8
eSATA port
9
USB port
10
Power on/off button
11
Fan
12
Audio input
13
Bidirectional talk input port
14
15
16
17
Bidirectional talk output port
Audio output
Video output
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
2.2.17 960H 4HDD 1.5U Series
The 16-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-44.
Figure 2-44
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Power button
2
Fan
3
Video input
4
Audio output
5
Bidirectional talk output port
121
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Bidirectional talk input port
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
GND port
Power input port
Audio input /Matrix video output/Loop video
output
Video SPOT output
Video VGA output
HDMI port
14
15
16
17
eSATA port
USB port
RS232 port
Network port
2.2.18 960H 2HDD 1.5U Series
This series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-45.
Please note the following figure is based on the 8-channel series product.
Figure 2-45
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Audio input
4
Audio output
5
RS232 port
6
Power button
7
Video SPOT output
8
Bidirectional talk input
9
Video VGA output
10
HDMI output
11
USB port
12
Network port
13
RS485 port
14
Power socket
15
Alarm input/alarm output/RS485 port
16
GND port
2.2.19 2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-46.
122
Figure 2-46
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Video input
2
Video output
3
Video SPOT output
4
Audio input
5
Audio output
6
Bidirectional talk input
7
RS232 port
8
Video VGA output
9
Alarm input/alarm output
10
HDMI port
11
USB port
12
Network port
13
RS485 port
14
Power input port
15
Power button
2.2.20 4HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-47.
Figure 2-47
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Power button
2
Power input port
3
Fan
4
RS232 port
5
Video input
6
Video VGA output
7
Video SPOT output
8
Video output
9
Audio input
10
HDMI port
11
eSATA port
12
Audio output
123
13
Bidirectional talk input
14
USB port
15
RS485 port
16
Alarm input/alarm output
17
Network port
18
GND port
The special 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-48.
Figure 2-48
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power button
3
Fan
4
RS232 port
5
Video input
6
Video output
7
Audio input
8
Audio output
9
Alarm input/alarm output
10
Network port
11
RS485 port
12
USB port
13
Bidirectional talk input
14
eSATA port
15
HDMI port
16
Video SPOT output
17
Video VGA output
18
Video loop output
2.2.21 General 2U Series/24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series
This series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-49.
Please note the following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
124
Figure 2-49
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Power button
4
Fan
5
DB25 port ( 5th to 16th-channel audio input port)
6
1st to 4th-channel audio input
7
Loop video output
8
Video input
9
Video CVBS output
10
Matrix video output
11
Audio output
12
Bidirectional talk input port
13
Bidirectional talk output port
14
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port HDMI
port
15
Video VGA output
16
HDMI port
17
Video CVBS output RS232 port
18
Video matrix output eSATA port
19
USB port
20
Network port
The 32-channel series DVR rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-50.
Figure 2-50
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Power button
4
Fan
5
1st to 4th-channel audio input
6
DB25 port ( 5th to 16th-channel audio input port)
7
Video input
8
Video CVBS output
9
Matrix video output
10
Audio output
11
Bidirectional talk input port
12
Bidirectional talk output port
13
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
14
Network port
125
15
16
17
18
19
HDMI port
RS232 port
eSATA port
USB port
Video VGA output
2.2.22 HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series
The rear panel 4/8-channel series product is shown as in Figure 2-51.
Figure 2-51
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Video input
4
Bidirectional talk input port
5
Video output
6
Network port
7
Video VGA output
8
RS232 port
9
HDMI port
10
eSATA port
11
USB port
12
Power button
13
Fan
14
15
16
17
Audio input
Bidirectional talk output port
Audio output
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
The rear panel of the 16-channel series product is shown as in Figure 2-52.
126
Figure 2-52
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Video input
4
Bidirectional talk input port
5
Video output
6
Network port
7
Video VGA output
8
RS232 port
9
HDMI port
10
eSATA port
11
USB port
12
Power on/off button
13
Fan
14
15
16
17
Audio input
Bidirectional talk output port
Audio output
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
2.2.23 960H 2U Series
The rear panel is shown as in Figure 2-53.
Please note the following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
Figure 2-53
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power input port
3
Power button
127
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Fan
DB25 port (5-16 channel audio input)
1-4channel audio input
Loop video output
Video input
Video CVBS output
Matrix video output
Audio output
Bidirectional talk input port
Bidirectional talk output port
14
15
16
17
18
Alarm input/Alarm output/RS485 port
Video VGA output
HDMI port
RS-232
eSATA port
19
20
USB port
Network port
2.2.24 8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level
The 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-54.
Figure 2-54
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
Power button
2
Fan
3
Video input
4
GND port
5
Power input port
6
Video output
7
Video SPOT output
8
Video output
9
Audio output
10
Bidirectional talk input
11
Audio input
12
Video VGA output
13
HDMI output
14
Alarm input/alarm output
15
eSATA port
16
USB port
17
RS485 port
18
Network port
128
The special 16-channel series rear panel is shown as below. See Figure 2-55.
Figure 2-55
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
1
GND port
2
Power button
3
Fan
4
Audio input
5
Video input
6
Network port
7
RS485 port
8
USB port
9
eSATA port
10
Alarm input/alarm output
11
HDMI output
12
Video VGA output
13
RS232 port
14
Bidirectional talk input
15
Audio output
16
Video loop output
17
Video SPOT output
18
Video output
When connect the Ethernet port, please use crossover cable to connect the PC and use the
straight cable to connect to the switcher or router.
2.3 Connection Sample
2.3.1 Smart 1U/Mini 1U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-56 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1U series product.
129
Figure 2-56
2.3.2 General 1U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-57 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 8-channel series product.
130
Figure 2-57
2.3.3 960H 1U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-58 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 8-channel series product.
131
Figure 2-58
2.3.4 HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series
The connection sample is shown as in Figure 2-59.
132
Figure 2-59
2.3.5 2HDD 1U Entry-level Series/2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
Please refer to Figure 2-60 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 2HDD 1U entry-level series product.
133
Figure 2-60
2.3.6 General 1.5U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-61 for connection sample.
134
Figure 2-61
2.3.7 HD-SDI 1.5U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-62 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
135
Figure 2-62
2.3.8 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series/Simple1.5U Series
The following figure is based on the 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U 16-channel series product. See Figure
2-63.
136
Figure 2-63
2.3.9 2HDD CIF 1.5U Series/24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U
The following figure is based on the 2HDD CIF 1.5U 32-channel series product. See Figure 2-64.
137
Figure 2-64
2.3.10 960H 4HDD 1.5U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-65 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
138
Figure 2-65
2.3.11 960H 2HDD 1.5U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-66 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 8-channel series product.
139
Figure 2-66
2.3.12 4HDD Full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
Please refer to Figure 2-67 for connection sample.
140
Figure 2-67
2.3.13 General 2U series/24/32-ch 2CIF 2U Series
Please refer to Figure 2-68 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the general 2U 16-channel series product.
141
Figure 2-68
2.3.14 HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series
Please refer to the following figure for detailed information. See Figure 2-69.
The following figure is based on the 8-channel series product.
142
Figure 2-69
2.3.15 960H 2U Series
Please refer to the following figure for detailed information. See Figure 2-70.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
143
Figure 2-70
2.3.16 8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series
Please refer to Figure 2-71 for connection sample.
The following figure is based on the 16-channel series product.
144
Figure 2-71
2.4 Remote Control
Control
The remote control interface is shown as in Figure 2-72.
Please note remote control is not our standard accessory and it is not included in the accessory
bag.
145
Figure 2-72
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Serial Number
Name
Function
1
Power button
Click it to boot up or shut down
the device.
2
Address
Click it to input device number,
so that you can control it.
3
Forward
4
Slow play
Various forward speeds and
normal speed playback.
Multiple slow play speeds or
normal playback.
In playback mode, playback the
next video.
In playback mode, playback the
previous video.
In pause mode, click this button
to realize normal playback.
In normal playback click this
button to pause playback.
In real-time monitor mode, click
this button to enter video search
menu.
Reverse playback pause mode,
click this button to realize normal
playback.
In reverse playback click this
button to pause playback.
Next record
5
Previous record
6
7
Play/Pause
Reverse/pause
8
146
Cancel
9
10
Record
11
Direction keys
12
Confirm /menu key
13
Multiple-window switch
14
Auxiliary key
15
0-9 number key
Go back to previous menu or
cancel current operation (close
upper interface or control)
Start or stop record manually
In record interface, working with
the direction buttons to select the
record channel.
Click this button for at least 1.5
seconds, system can go to the
Manual Record interface.
Switch current activated control,
go to left or right.
In playback mode, click up/down
button to switch playback
channel. In 1-window playback
mode, click left/right button to
control playback speed. .
Aux function(such as switch the
PTZ menu, enable/disable reuse
button)
go to default button
go to the menu
Switch between multiple-window
and one-window.
In 1-ch monitor mode: pop up
assistant function:PTZ control
and Video color.
Switch the PTZ control menu in
PTZ control interface.
In motion detection interface,
working with direction keys to
complete setup.
In text mode, click it to delete
character.
Input password, channel or
switch channel.
Shift is the button to switch the
input method.
2.5 Mouse Control
Left click
mouse
System pops up password input dialogue box if you have not logged in.
In real-time monitor mode, you can go to the main menu.
When you have selected one menu item, left click mouse to view menu
content.
Implement the control operation.
Modify checkbox or motion detection status.
Click combo box to pop up drop down list
147
In input box, you can select input methods. Left click the corresponding
button on the panel you can input numeral/English character
(small/capitalized). Here ← stands for backspace button. _ stands for space
button.
In English input mode: _stands for input a backspace icon and ← stands for
deleting the previous character.
In numeral input mode: _ stands for clear and ← stands for deleting the
previous numeral.
When input special sign, you can click corresponding numeral in the front
panel to input. For example, click numeral 1 you can input“/” , or you can click
the numeral in the on-screen keyboard directly.
Double left
click mouse
Right click
mouse
Press
middle
button
Move
mouse
Drag mouse
Implement special control operation such as double click one item in the file
list to playback the video.
In multiple-window mode, double left click one channel to view in full-window.
Double left click current video again to go back to previous multiple-window
mode.
In real-time monitor mode, pops up shortcut menu: one-window, four-window,
nine-window and sixteen-window, Pan/Tilt/Zoom, color setting, search,
record, alarm input, alarm output, main menu.
Among which, Pan/Tilt/Zoom and color setting applies for current selected
channel.
If you are in multiple-window mode, system automatically switches to the
corresponding channel.
Exit current menu without saving the modification.
In numeral input box: Increase or decrease numeral value.
Switch the items in the check box.
Page up or page down
Select current control or move control
Select motion detection zone
Select privacy mask zone.
148
2.6 Virtual Keyboard & Front Panel
2.6.1 Virtual Keyboard
The system supports two input methods: numeral input and English character (small and
capitalized) input.
Move the cursor to the text column, the text is shown as blue, input button pops up on the right.
Click that button to switch between numeral input and English input (capitalized and small),
Use > or < to shift between small character and capitalized character.
2.6.2 Front Panel
Move the cursor to the text column. Click Fn key and use direction keys to select number you
wanted. Please click enter button to input.
149
3 Installation and Connections
Note: All the installation and operations here should conform to your local
electric safety rules.
3.1 Check Unpacked DVR
When you receive the DVR from the forwarding agent, please check whether there is any visible
damage. The protective materials used for the package of the DVR can protect most accidental
clashes during transportation. Then you can open the box to check the accessories.
Please check the items in accordance with the list. Finally you can remove the protective film of
the DVR.
3.2 About Front Panel
Panel and Real Panel
The model label in the front panel is very important; please check according to your purchase
order.
The label in the rear panel is very important too. Usually we need you to represent the serial
number when we provide the service after sales.
3.3 HDD Installation
Before the installation, you can refer to the sheet to know the max HDD amount your product
supports.
Product Series
Max HDD No.
Mini 1U
General 2CIF real-time mini 1U
1
General full-D1 mini IU
1
Enhanced 2CIF real-time mini
1
1U
Enhanced full-D1 mini 1U
1
1U
General 1U
2
960H 1U
HD-SDI 1080P 1U
2HDD 1U entry-level
2
2
2
1.5U
Full-D1 1.5U
4
HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U
4
960H 4HDD 1.5U
4
960H 2HDD 1.5U
2HDD full-D1 1.5U entry-level
4HDD full-D1 1.5U entry-level
4/8/16-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U
Simple1.5U
2HDD CIF 1.5U
2
2
4
2
2
2
24/32-ch 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U
2
2U
150
General 2U
960H
8
8
HD-SDI
8HDD Full-D1 2U entry-level
8
8
24/32-ch 2CIF 2U
8
SMART 1U
(Enhanced) 1HDD Full-D1 Smart 1
(Enhanced) 1HDD CIF Smart
1
You can refer to the Appendix for recommended HDD brand. Please use HDD of 7200rpm or
higher.
Please follow the instructions below to install hard disk.
All the figurers listed below are for reference only. Slight difference may be found on the
front or rear panel.
3.3.1 SMART 1U Series
1. Loosen the screws of the
2. Fix four screws in the HDD
3. Place the HDD in accordance with
upper cover and side panel.
(Turn just three rounds).
the four holes in the bottom.
4. Turn the device upside down
5. Fix the HDD firmly.
and then turn the screws in
6. Connect the HDD cable and
power cable.
firmly.
7. Put the cover in accordance
8. Secure the screws in the
with the clip and then place the
rear panel and the side panel.
upper cover back.
151
3.3.2 Mini 1U/1U Series
The mini 1U series DVR has one SATA HDD and 1U series DVR has two SATA HDDs.
1. Loosen the screws of the
2. Fix four screws in the HDD
3. Place the HDD in accordance with
upper cover and side panel.
(Turn just three rounds).
the four holes in the bottom.
4. Turn the device upside down
5. Fix the HDD firmly.
and then turn the screws in
6. Connect the HDD cable and
power cable.
firmly.
7. Put the cover in accordance
8. Secure the screws in the
with the clip and then place the
rear panel and the side panel.
upper cover back.
3.3.3 1.5U series
This series DVR max has four SATA HDDs. Please use HDD of 7200rpm or higher.
1. Loosen the screws of the
2. Line up the HDD to the four
upper cover.
holes of the HDD bracket.
3. Use four screws to fix HDD.
152
4. Unfasten the HDD power
5. Use the special data cable to
6. Insert the HDD power cable.
cable.
connect the HDD and the SATA
Close the chassis and fix the
port
screws to secure firmly.
3.3.4 2U series (HD-SDI series, 960H )
This series DVR max supports 8 SATA HDDs. Please use HDD of 7200rpm or higher.
1. Loosen the screws of the
2. Remove the HDD upper
3. Now you can see the bottom
upper cover.
bracket
bracket
4. Line up the HDD to the
four
holes
of
the
5. Use screws to fix HDD.
HDD
6. Install the upper bracket and then
Use screws to fix HDD in the
bracket.
bracket.
7. Unfasten the HDD power
8. Insert the HDD power
9. Use the special data cable to
cable.
cable.
connect the HDD and the SATA
port. Close the chassis and fix
the screws to secure firmly.
Important:
If the HDD amount is less than four, you do not need to install the HDD bracket.
When there is a bracket, please make sure the installation direction of HDDs is the same.
153
3.4 Rack Installation
Please note this installation mode is for 1.5U/2U series product.
Please follow the steps listed below.
Use twelve screws to fix the unit
Please make sure the indoor temperature is below 35℃ (95°f).
Please make sure there is 15cm (6 inches) space around the device to guarantee sound
ventilation.
Please install from the bottom to the top.
If there are more accessories connected in the rack, please take precaution measures in
case the rack power is overload.
3.5 Connecting Power Supply
Please check input voltage and device power button match or not.
We recommend you use UPS to guarantee steady operation, DVR life span, and other peripheral
equipments operation such as cameras.
3.6 Connecting Video Input and Output Devices
3.6.1 Connecting Video Input
The video input interface is BNC. The input video format includes: PAL/NTSC BNC(1.0V P- P ,
75Ω.).For HD-SDI series product: BNC(0.8VP-P,75Ω).
The video signal should comply with your national standards.
The input video signal shall have high SNR, low distortion; low interference, natural color and
suitable lightness.
Guarantee the stability and reliability of the camera signal:
The camera shall be installed in a cool, dry place away from direct sunlight, inflammable,
explosive substances and etc.
The camera and the DVR should have the same grounding to ensure the normal operation of the
camera.
Guarantee stability and reliability of the transmission line
Please use high quality, sound shielded BNC. Please select suitable BNC model according to the
transmission distance.
If the distance is too long, you should use twisted pair cable, and you can add video
compensation devices or use optical fiber to ensure video quality.
You should keep the video signal away from the strong electromagnetic interference, especially
the high tension current.
Keep connection lugs in well contact
The signal line and shielded wire should be fixed firmly and in well connection. Avoid dry joint,
lap welding and oxidation.
B
B
BTTTB
BTTTB
BTTTB
3.6.2 Connecting Video Output
Video output includes a BNC(PAL/NTSC1.0VP-P ,75Ω)output ,a VGA output and HDMI output.
System supports BNC, VGA and HDMI output at the same time.
154
When you are using pc-type monitor to replace the monitor, please pay attention to the following
points:
To defer aging, do not allow the pc monitor to run for a long time.
Regular demagnetization will keep device maintain proper status.
Keep it away from strong electromagnetic interference devices.
Using TV as video output device is not a reliable substitution method. You also need to reduce
the working hour and control the interference from power supply and other devices. The low
quality TV may result in device damage.
3.7 Connecting Audio Input & Output,
Output, Bidirectional Audio
3.7.1 Audio Input
These series products audio input port adopt BNC port.
Due to high impedance of audio input, please use active sound pick-up.
Audio transmission is similar to video transmission. Try to avoid interference, dry joint, loose
contact and it shall be away from high tension current.
3.7.2 Audio Output
The audio output signal parameter is usually over 200mv 1KΩ (BNC). It can directly connect to
low impedance earphone, active sound box or amplifier-drive audio output device.
If the sound box and the pick-up cannot be separated spatially, it is easy to arouse squeaking. In
this case you can adopt the following measures:
Use better sound pick-up with better directing property.
Reduce the volume of the sound box.
Using more sound-absorbing materials in decoration can reduce voice echo and improve
acoustics environment.
Adjust the layout to reduce happening of the squeaking.
3.8 Alarm Input and Output Connection
Please refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output connection.
There are two alarm input types for you to select: normal open (NO) and normal close (NC).
1. Alarm input
a. Please make sure alarm input mode is grounding alarm input.
b. Grounding signal is needed for alarm input.
c. Alarm input needs the low level voltage signal.
d. Alarm input mode can be either NC (normal Open) or NO (Normal Close)
e. When you are connecting two DVRs or you are connecting one DVR and one other device,
please use a relay to separate them,
2. Alarm output
The alarm output port should not be connected to high power load directly (It shall be less than
1A) to avoid high current which may result in relay damage. Please use the co contactor to
realize the connection between the alarm output port and the load.
3. How to connect PTZ decoder
155
a. Ensure the decoder has the same grounding with DVR, otherwise you may not control the PTZ.
Shielded twisted wire is recommended and the shielded layer is used to connect to the grounding.
b. Avoid high voltage. Ensure proper wiring and some thunder protection measures.
c. For too long signal wires, 120Ω should be parallel connected between A, B lines on the far end
to reduce reflection and guarantee the signal quality.
d. “485 A, B” of DVR cannot parallel connect with “485 port” of other device.
e. The voltage between of A,B lines of the decoder should be less than 5v.
4. Please make sure the front-end device has soundly earthed.
Improper grounding may result in chip damage.
3.8.1 Alarm Input and Output Details
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
Important
Please refer to the specifications for the alarm input and output channel amount. Do not
merely count the alarm input and out channel amount according to the ports on the rear
panel.
X
3.8.1.1 General 1U Series
The 4/8-channel series product interface is shown as below. See Figure 3-1.
AB cable
connection
Figure 3-1
Please refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-1 for detailed information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 8. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
In the second line,
from the left to the
right,: 1,2,3,4,
5,6,7,8.
In the first line, from There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
the left to the right:
button)
1-NO C,2-NO C,
3-NO C
Earth cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
The 16-channel interface is shown as in Figure 3-2.
156
AB cable
connection
Figure 3-2
Please refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-2 for detailed information.
In the second line,
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
from the left to the
right,: 1,2,3,4,
5,6,7,8.and the
first line from the left
to the right : 9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
In the first line, from There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
the left to the right:
button)
3-NO C,and the
second line from the
left to the right 1NO C,2-NO C.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.2 960H 1U Series
The interface is shown as below. See Figure 3-3.
Figure 3-3
Please refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-3 for detailed information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 8. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
NO1 C1,
button)
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3
Earth cable.
157
3.8.1.3 HD-SDI 1080P 1U Series
The interface is shown as below. See Figure 3-4.
Figure 3-4
Please refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-5 for detailed information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 4. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4
NO1 C1,
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
button)
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
Earth cable.
3.8.1.4 2HDD 1U Entry-level Series
The interface is shown as below. See Figure 3-5.
Figure 3-5
Please refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-5 for detailed information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 8. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
NO1 C1,
button)
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3
Earth cable.
3.8.1.5 Full-D1 1.5U and Simple 1.5U Series
The 1.5U series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-6.
158
AB cable
connection
Figure 3-6
You can refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-6 for alarm input and output information.
In the first line, from ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
the left to the right,:
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
In the second line,
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
from the left to the
(on/off button)
right:
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
NO1 C1,
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
+12V
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.6 HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U Series
The HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U series product interface is shown as in
Figure 3-7.
Figure 3-7
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
159
NO1 C1,
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
+12V
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
(on/off button)
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
T+, T-, R+, R-
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
4-pin full-duplex RS485 port. T+,T- are the output cable and R+,
R- are input cable.
3.8.1.7 960H 4HDD 1.5U Series
The 960H 4HDD 1.5U series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-8.
Figure 3-8
You can refer to the following sheet and Figure 3-6 for alarm input and output information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
NO1 C1,
(on/off button)
NO2 C2,
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
+12V
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.8 960H 2HDD 1.5U Series
The 960H 2HDD 1.5U series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-9.
The following interface is based on the 16-channel series product.
160
Figure 3-9
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
NO1 C1,
button).
NO2 C2,
NO3 C3,
Earth cable.
3.8.1.9 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U Series
The 2HDD 2CIF 1.5U series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-10.
Figure 3-10
You can refer to the following sheet for detailed information
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
1-NO C,2-NO C,
button).
3-NO C
Earth cable.
3.8.1.10 2HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
The 2HDD full-D1 1.5U entry-level series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-11.
161
Figure 3-11
You can refer to the following sheet for detailed information
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
1-NO C,2-NO C,
button).
3-NO C
Earth cable.
3.8.1.11 4HDD full-D1 1.5U Entry-level Series
The 4HDD full-D1 1.5U entry-level series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-12.
Figure 3-12
You can refer to the following sheet for detailed information
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
NO1 C1,NO2 C2, There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
button).
NO3 C3
Earth cable.
3.8.1.12 General 2U Series
The general 2U series product interface is shown as in
Figure 3-13.
Figure 3-13
AB cable
connection
162
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
NO1 C1,
(on/off button)
NO2 C2,
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
+12V
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.13 HD-SDI 1080P 2U Series
HD-SDI 1080P 2U series interface is shown as below. See Figure 3-14.
Figure 3-14
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
NO1 C1,
(on/off button)
NO2 C2,
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
+12V
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
485 A/B
T+, T-, R+, R485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
4-pin full-duplex RS485 port. T+,T- are the output cable and R+,
R- are input cable.
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.14 960H 2U Series
163
960H 2U series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-15.
Figure 3-15
You can refer to the following sheet for alarm input and output information.
1,2,3,4,, 5, 6, 7, ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13,
14, 15, 16
The first four are four groups of normal open activation output
NO1 C1,
(on/off button)
NO2 C2,
NO5 C5 NC5 is a group of NO/NC activation output (on/off button)
NO3 C3,
NO4 C4,
NO5 C5 NC5
CTRL 12V
+12V
Control power output. The power output is off when the alarm is
canceled.
It is rated power output.
Earth cable.
T+, T-, R+, R-
4-pin full-duplex RS485 port. T+,T- are the output cable and R+,
R- are input cable.
485 A/B
485 communication port. They are used to control devices such as
PTZ. Please parallel connect 120TΩ between A/B cables if there are
too many PTZ decoders.
3.8.1.15 8HDD Full-D1 2U Entry-level Series
The 8HDD full-D1 2U entry-level series product interface is shown as in Figure 3-16.
Figure 3-16
You can refer to the following sheet for detailed information
ALARM 1 to ALARM 16. The alarm becomes active in low voltage.
1,2,3,4,5,
6,7,8,9,10,
11,12,13,14,
15,16
1-NO C,2-NO C, There are three groups of normal open activation output (on/off
button).
3-NO C
Earth cable.
3.8.2 Alarm Input Port
Please refer to the following sheet for more information.
Normal open or Normal close type.
Please parallel connect COM end and GND end of the alarm detector (Provide external
power to the alarm detector).
Please parallel connect the Ground of the DVR and the ground of the alarm detector.
164
Please connect the NC port of the alarm sensor to the DVR alarm input(ALARM)
Use the same ground with that of DVR if you use external power to the alarm device.
Figure 3-17
3.8.3 Alarm Output Port
Provide power to peripheral alarm device.
To avoid overloading, please read the following relay parameters sheet carefully.
RS485 A/B cable is for the A/B cable of the PTZ decoder.
Relay Specification
Model:
JRC-27F
Material of the
touch
Silver
Rating
(Resistance
Load)
Rated switch capacity
30VDC 2A, 125VAC 1A
Maximum switch power
125VA 160W
Maximum switch voltage
250VAC, 220VDC
Maximum switch currency
Between touches with same
polarity
1A
Between touches with different
polarity
1000VAC 1minute
Between touch and winding
Between touches with same
polarity
3ms max
1000VAC 1minute
Insulation
Surge voltage
Length of open
time
1000VAC 1minute
1500V (10×160us)
Length of close
time
3ms max
Longevity
Mechanical
50×106 times (3Hz)
Electrical
200×103 times (0.5Hz)
Temperature
-40℃ ~+70℃
3.9 RS232
You can connect the DVR with POS or Keyboard through RS232.
With POS system, the DVR can communicate through RS232 and network. For the POS system, the
DVR can integrate the text content and even search the record through the info.
165
The series DVR also support NKB operation. You can operate the DVR from the keyboard controls
instead of using the control pad on the front panel of the unit.
To connect a NKB keyboard to the DVR:
1. Assemble the KBD keyboard according to the instructions in its accompanying installation manual.
2. Connect the KBD keyboard into one of the RS232 ports on the DVR or through network.
3.10 RS485
When the DVR receives a camera control command, it transmits that command up the coaxial cable
to the PTZ device. RS485 is a single-direction protocol; the PTZ device can’t return any data to the
unit. To enable the operation, connect the PTZ device to the RS485 (A,B) input on the DVR. See
Figure 3-8 .
Since RS485 is disabled by default for each camera, you must enable the PTZ settings first. This
series DVRs support multiple protocols such as Pelco-D, Pelco-P.
To connect PTZ devices to the DVR:
1. Connect RS485 A,B on the DVR rear panel.
2. Connect the other end of the cable to the proper pins in the connector on the camera.
3. Please follow the instructions to configure a camera to enable each PTZ device on the DVR.
X289H289H28 9H
X
3.11 Other Interfaces
There are still other interfaces on the DVR, such as USB ports. You can refer to the Figure 3-18 for
more information.
1U series
166
1.5U Series
2U Series
Figure 3-18
167
4 Overview of Navigation and Controls
Note:
All the operations listed below are based on the 2U series product.
Before operation, please make sure:
You have properly installed HDD and all the cable connections.
The provided input power and the device power are matched.
The external power shall be DC 12V or AC90~264V 50+2% Hz.
Always use the stable current, if necessary UPS is a best alternative measure.
4.1 Login, Logout & Main Menu
4.1.1 Login
After system booted up, system pops up the startup wizard.
Click the Cancel button; you can go to the system login interface.
Click the Next Step button; you can go to the startup wizard interface. Here you can set the
system basic information. See Figure 4-1.
Figure 4-1
The system login interface is shown as in Figure 4-2.
System consists of four accounts:
Username: admin. Password: admin. (administrator, local and network)
Username: 888888. Password: 888888. (administrator, local only)
Username: 666666. Password: 666666(Lower authority user who can only monitor, playback,
backup and etc.)
Username: default. Password: default(hidden user)
You can use USB mouse, front panel, or keyboard to input. About input method: Click
to
switch between numeral, English character (small/capitalized) and denotation.
Note:
For security reason, please modify password after you first login.
Continuous three times login failure will result in system alarm and five times login failure will
result in account lock!
168
Figure 4-2
4.1.2
Main Menu
After you logged in, the system main menu is shown as below. See Figure 4-3.
There are total six icons: search, information, setting, backup, advanced and shutdown.
You can move the cursor to highlight the icon, and then double click mouse to enter the submenu.
Figure 4-3
4.1.3
Logout
There are two ways for you to log out.
One is from menu option:
In the main menu, click shutdown button, you can see an interface is shown as below. See
Figure 4-4.
Figure 4-4
There are several options for you. See Figure 4-5.
Figure 4-5
169
The other ways is to press power button on the front panel for at least 3 seconds, system will
stop all operations. Then you can click the power button in the rear panel to turn off the DVR.
4.1.4
Auto Resume after Power Failure
The system can automatically backup video and resume previous working status after power
failure.
4.1.5 Replace Button Battery
Please make sure to use the same battery model if possible.
We recommend replace battery regularly (such as one-year) to guarantee system time
accuracy.
Note:
Before replacement, please save the system setup, otherwise, you may lose the data
completely!
4.2 Live Viewing
Viewing
After you logged in, the system is in live viewing mode. You can see system date, time and
channel name. If you want to change system date and time, you can refer to general settings
(Main Menu->Setting->General). If you want to modify the channel name, please refer to the
display settings (Main Menu->Setting->Display).
1
Recording status
3
Video loss
2
Motion detection
4
Camera lock
Tips
Preview drag: If you want to change position of channel 1 and channel 16 when you are
previewing, you can left click mouse in the channel 1 and then drag to channel 16,
release mouse you can switch channel 1 and channel 16 positions.
Use mouse middle button to control window split: You can use mouse middle button to
switch window split amount.
Preview Control
The preview control function has the following features.
Support preview playback.
In the preview desktop, system can playback previous 5-60 minutes record of
current channel. Please go to the Main Menu->General to set real-time playback
time.
Support drag and play function. You can use your mouse to select any playback
start time.
Support playback, pause and exit function.
Right now, system does not support slow playback and backward playback function.
Support digital zoom function.
Support real-time backup function.
You can follow the contents listed below for the operation instruction.
Preview control interface
170
Move you mouse to the top centre of the video of current channel, you can see system pops
up the preview control interface. See Figure 4-6. If your mouse stays in this area for more
than 6 seconds and has no operation, the control bar automatically hides.
1
2
3
4
Figure 4-6
You can refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
SN
Name
Function
1
Realtime playback
2
Digital zoom
It is to playback the previous 5-60 minutes
record of current channel.
Please go to the Main Menu->General to set
real-time playback time.
System may pop up a dialogue box if there is no
such record in current channel.
It is to zoom in specified zone of current
channel. It supports zoom in function of multiplechannel.
The selected area has an icon as
3
Real-time backup
function
and the
.
free area is shown as an icon as
It is to backup the video of current channel to
the USB device. System can not backup the
video of multiple-channel at the same time.
Current selected backup channel has an icon as
and the free channel is shown as an icon as
..
Once the backup started, you can see the free
channel is shown as an icon as
4
.
Exit
Playback control
The playback control has the following features.
Support play, pause, and exit and drag function.
During the preview playback process, you can not see the channel title and record status
of current channel. It will display the channel title and the record status once you exit the
preview playback.
During the preview playback, you can not switch the displayed channel or change
current window-display mode.
Please note the tour function has the higher priority than the preview playback. You can
not control the preview playback until the tour function ended.
4.3 Manual Record
Note:
171
You need to have proper rights to implement the following operations. Please make sure the
HDD has been properly installed.
4.3.1 Manual record menu
There are two ways for you to go to manual record menu.
Right click mouse or in the main menu, Advanced->Manual Record.
In live viewing mode, click record button in the front panel or record button in the remote
control.
Manual record menu is shown as in Figure 4-7.
4.3.2 Basic operation
There are two modes: main stream and extra stream. There are three statuses:
schedule/manual/stop. Please highlight icon“○” to select corresponding channel.
Manual: The highest priority. After manual setup, all selected channels will begin ordinary
recording.
Schedule: Channel records as you have set in recording setup (Main Menu->Setting>Schedule)
Stop: All channels stop recording.
Figure 4-7
4.3.3 Enable/disable record
Please check current channel status: “○” means it is not in recording status, “●” means it is in
recording status.
You can use mouse or direction key to highlight channel number. See Figure 4-8.
Figure 4-8
172
4.3.4 Enable all channel recording
Highlight ○ below All, you can enable all channel recording.
All channel schedule record
Please highlight “ALL” after “Schedule”. See Figure 4-9.
When system is in schedule recording, all channels will record as you have previously set
(Main menu->Setting->Schedule).
The corresponding indication light in front panel will turn on.
Figure 4-9
All channel manual record
Please highlight “ALL” after “Manual.” See Figure 4-10.
When system is in manual recording, all scheduled set up you have set in will be null ((Main
menu->Setting->Schedule)).
You can see indication light in front panel turns on, system begins manual record now.
Figure 4-10
4.3.5 Stop all channel recording
Please highlight “ALL” after “Stop”. See Figure 4-11.
System stops all channel recording no matter what mode you have set in the menu (Main
menu->Setting->Schedule)
173
Figure 4-11
4.4 Search & Playback
Click search button in the main menu, search interface is shown as below. See Figure 4-12.
Usually there are three file types:
R: Regular recording file.
A: External alarm recording file.
M: Motion detection recording file.
Figure 4-12
Please refer to the following sheet for more information.
SN
1
Name
Display
window
Function
Here is to display the searched picture or file.
Support 1/4/9/16-window playback.
174
2
Search
type
3
Calendar
4
Playback
mode
and
channel
selection
pane.
5
Card
number
search
Here you can select to search the picture or the recorded file.
You can select to play from the read-write HDD, from peripheral device or from
redundancy HDD.
Before you select to play from the peripheral device, please connect the
corresponding peripheral device. You can view all record files of the root directory
of the peripheral device. Click the Browse button; you can select the file you want
to play.
Important
Redundancy HDD does not support picture backup function, but it
supports picture playback function. You can select to play from redundancy
HDD if there are pictures on the redundancy HDD.
The blue highlighted date means there is picture or file. Otherwise, there is no
picture or file.
In any play mode, click the date you want to see, you can see the corresponding
record file trace in the time bar.
Playback mode:1/4/9/16. (It may vary due to different series.)
In 1-window playback mode: you can select 1-16 channels.
In 4-window playback mode: you can select 4 channels according to your
requirement.
In 9-window playback mode, you can switch between 1-8 and 9-16 channels.
In 16-window playback mode, you can switch between1-16 and 17-32
channels.
The time bar will change once you modify the playback mode or the channel
option.
The card number search interface is shown as below. Here you can view card
number/field setup bar. You cam implement advanced search.
Double click it, you can view the picture/record file list of current day.
The file list is to display the first channel of the record file.
The system can display max 128 files in one time. Use the ⊳│and │ or the
mouse to view the file. Select one item, and then double click the mouse or click
the ENTER button to playback.
You can input the period in the following interface to begin accurate search.
File type:R—regular record; A—external alarm record;M—Motion detect
record.
6
File list
switch
button
Lock file. Click the file you want to lock and click the button
you locked will not be overwritten.
Search locked file: Click the button
7
8
Mark file
list button
Playback
control
pane.
to lock. The file
to view the locked file.
Return: Click button
, system goes back to the calendar and channel setup
interface.
Please note:
For the file that is writing or overwriting, it can not be locked.
Click it to go to mark file list interface. You can view all mark information of current
channel by time. Please refer to chapter 4.4.3 for detailed information.
Please note only the product of this icon supports mark function.
►/
Play/Pause
There are three ways for you to begin playback.
The play button
Double click the valid period of the time bar.
Double click the item in the file list.
175
In slow play mode, click it to switch between play/pause.
■
⊳
│⊳/
│
►
Stop
Backward play
In normal play mode, left click the button, the file begins backward play.
Click it again to pause current play.
In backward play mode, click ►/ to restore normal play.
In playback mode, click it to play the next or the previous section. You can
click continuously when you are watching the files from the same channel.
In normal play mode, when you pause current play, you can click ⊳│ and
│ to begin frame by frame playback.
In frame by frame playback mode, click ►/ to restore normal playback.
Slow play
In playback mode, click it to realize various slow play modes such as slow
play 1, slow play 2, and etc.
Fast forward
In playback mode, click to realize various fast play modes such as fast
play 1,fast play 2 and etc.
Note: The actual play speed has relationship with the software version.
Smart search
The volume of the playback
Click the snapshot button in the full-screen mode, the system can snapshot
1 picture.
System supports custom snap picture saved path. Please connect the
peripheral device first, click snap button on the full-screen mode, you can
select or create path. Click Start button, the snapshot picture can be saved
to the specified path.
9
Time bar
10
Time bar
unit
11
Backup
Mark button.
Please note this function is for some series product only. Please make sure
there is a mark button in the playback control pane.
You can refer to chapter 4.4.3 for detailed information.
It is to display the record type and its period in current search criteria.
In 4-window playback mode, there are corresponding four time bars. In other
playback mode, there is only one time bar.
Use the mouse to click one point of the color zone in the time bar, system begins
playback.
The time bar is beginning with 0 o'clock when you are setting the configuration.
The time bar zooms in the period of the current playback time when you are
playing the file.
The green color stands for the regular record file. The red color stands for the
external alarm record file. The yellow stands for the motion detect record file.
●The option includes: 24H, 12H, 1H and 30M. The smaller the unit, the larger the
zoom rate. You can accurately set the time in the time bar to playback the record.
The time bar is beginning with 0 o'clock when you are setting the configuration.
The time bar zooms in the period of the current playback time when you are
playing the file.
Select the file(s) you want to backup from the file list. You can check from the
list. Then click the backup button, now you can see the backup menu. System
supports customized path setup. After select or create new folder, click the
176
Start button to begin the backup operation. The record file(s) will be saved in
the specified folder.
Check the file again you can cancel current selection. System max supports to
display 32 files from one channel.
After you clip on record file, click Backup button you can save it.
For one device, if there is a backup in process, you can not start a new
backup operation.
It is to edit the file.
●Please play the file you want to edit and then click this button when you want to
12
Clip
13
Record
type
edit. You can see the corresponding slide bars such as or in the time bar of
the corresponding channel. You can adjust the slide bar or input the accurate time
to set the file end time.
After you set, you can click Clip button again to edit the second period. You
can see the slide bar restore its previous position.
Click Backup button after clip, you can save current contents in a new file.
You can clip for one channel or multiple-channel. The multiple-channel click
operation is similar with the one-channel operation.
Please note:
System max supports 1024 files backup at the same time.
You can not operate clip operation if there is any file has been checked
in the file list.
In any play mode, the time bar will change once you modify the search type.
Other Functions
14
Smart
search
When system is playing, you can select a zone in the window to begin smart
search. Click the motion detect button to begin play.
Once the motion detect play has begun, click button again will terminate
current motion detect file play.
There is no motion detect zone by default.
If you select to play other file in the file list, system switches to motion detect
play of other file.
During the motion detect play process, you can not implement operations such
as change time bar, begin backward playback or frame by frame playback.
Please refer to chapter 4.4.1 Smart Search for detailed operation.
15
Other
channel
synchroni
zation
switch to
play
when
playback
When playing the file, click the number button, system can switch to the same
period of the corresponding channel to play.
16
Digital
zoom
When the system is in full-screen playback mode, left click the mouse in the
screen. Drag your mouse in the screen to select a section and then left click
mouse to realize digital zoom. You can right click mouse to exit.
17
Manually
switch
channel
when
playback
During the file playback process, you can switch to other channel via the
dropdown list or rolling the mouse.
This function is null if there is no record file or system is in smart search
process.
Note:
All the operations here (such as playback speed, channel, time and progress) have
relationship with hardware version. Some series DVRs do not support some functions or
playback speeds.
177
4.4.1 Smart Search
During the multiple-channel playback mode, double click one channel and then click the
button, system begins smart search. System supports 396(22*18 PAL) and 330(22*15 NTSC)
zones. Please left click mouse to select smart search zones. See Figure 4-13.
Figure 4-13
Click the
, you can go to the smart search playback. Click it again, system stops smart search
playback.
Important
System does not support motion detect zone setup during the full-screen mode.
During the multiple-channel playback, system stops playback of rest channels if you
implement one-channel smart search.
4.4.2 Accurate playback by time
Select records from one day, click the list, you can go to the file list interface. You can input
time at the top right corner to search records by time. For example, click time 06:00.00 and
then click Search button, you can view all the record files after 06:00.00 (The records
includes current time.). Click Play button, you can see system begins play from 06:00.00.
See Figure 4-14.
Note
After you searched files, system implement accurate playback once you click Play for the
first time.
System does not support accurate playback for picture.
System supports synchronization playback and non-synchronous playback. The
synchronization playback supports all channels and non-synchronous playback only
supports accurately playback of current select channel.
178
Figure 4-14
4.4.3 Mark Playback
Please make sure your purchased device support this function. You can use this function
only if you can see the mark playback icon on the Search interface (Figure 4-12).
When you are playback record, you can mark the record when there is important information.
After playback, you can use time or the mark key words to search corresponding record and then
play. It is very easy for you to get the important video information.
Add Mark
When system is playback, click Mark button
, you can go to the following interface. See Figure
4-15.
Figure 4-15
Playback Mark
During 1-window playback mode, click mark file list button
in Figure 4-12, you can go to
mark file list interface. Double click one mark file, you can begin playback from the mark time.
Play before mark time
Here you can set to begin playback from previous N seconds of the mark time.
Note
179
Usually, system can playbacks previous N seconds record if there is such kind of record file.
Otherwise, system playbacks from the previous X seconds when there is such as kind of record.
Mark Manager
Click the mark manager button
on the Search interface (Figure 4-12); you can go to Mark
Manager interface. See Figure 4-16. System can manage all the record mark information of
current channel by default. You can view all mark information of current channel by time.
Figure 4-16
Modify
Double click one mark information item, you can see system pops up a dialogue box for you to
change mark information. You can only change mark name here.
Delete
Here you can check the mark information item you want to delete and then click Delete button,
you can remove one mark item. .
Note
After you go to the mark management interface, system needs to pause current playback.
System resume playback after you exit mark management interface.
If the mark file you want to playback has been removed, system begin playbacking from the
first file in the list.
4.5 Schedule
After system booted up, it is in default 24-hour regular mode. You can set record type and
time in schedule interface.
4.5.1 Schedule Menu
In the main menu, from setting to schedule, you can go to schedule menu. See Figure 4-17.
180
Channel: Please select the channel number first. You can select “all” if you want to set for
the whole channels.
Week day: There are eight options: ranges from Saturday to Sunday and all.
Pre-record: System can pre-record the video before the event occurs into the file. The value
ranges from 1 to 30 seconds depending on the bit stream.
Redundancy: System supports redundancy backup function. It allows you backup recorded
file in two disks. You can highlight Redundancy button to activate this function. Please note,
before enable this function, please set at least one HDD as redundant. (Main menu>Advanced->HDD Management) Please refer to chapter 4.5.1.2 for detailed information.
Please note this function is null if there is only one HDD. The 4/8-channel HD-SDI
1080P 1.5U series product and the 4/8-channel HD-SDI 2U series product do not
support redundancy function. When the schedule or the manual status is checked on
the record control interface, redundancy HDD only backups record files. It does not
backup picture.
Snapshot: You can enable this function to snapshoot image when alarm occurs.
Record types: There are four types: regular, motion detection (MD), Alarm, MD & alarm.
Holiday setting: Click it you can see an interface shown as in Figure 4-18. Here you can set
holiday date. Check the box, it means current channel shall record as your holiday setup.
Please go to the Period interface to set the holiday date record setup. Please note you need
to go to Chapter 5.3.1 to enable Holiday function first.
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function. After completing all the setups
please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
At the bottom of the menu, there are color bars for your reference. Green color stands for
regular recording, yellow color stands for motion detection and red color stands for alarm
recording. The white means the MD and alarm record is valid. Once you have set to record
when the MD and alarm occurs, system will not record neither motion detect occurs nor the
alarm occurs.
Figure 4-17
181
Figure 4-18
4.5.1.1 Quick Setup
Copy function allows you to copy one channel setup to another. After setting in channel 1, click
Copy button, you can go to interface Figure 4-19. You can see current channel name is grey
such as channel 1. Now you can select the channel you wan to paste such as channel 5/6/7. If
you wan to save current setup of channel 1 to all channels, you can click the first box “ALL”. Click
the OK button to save current copy setup. Click the OK button in the Record interface, the copy
function succeeded.
Please note, if you select ALL in Figure 4-19, the record setup of all channels are the same and
the Copy button becomes hidden.
Figure 4-19
4.5.1.2 Redundancy
Redundancy function allows you to memorize record file in several disks. When there is file
damage occurred in one disk, there is a spare one in the other disk. You can use this
function to maintain data reliability and safety.
In the main menu, from Setting to Schedule, you can highlight redundancy button to enable
this function. See Figure 4-17.
In the main menu, from Advanced to HDD management, you can set one or more disk(s) as
redundant. You can select from the dropdown list. See Figure 4-20. System auto overwrites
old files once hard disk is full.
Please note only read/write disk or read-only disk can backup file and support file search
function, so you need to set at least one read-write disk otherwise you can not record video.
Note
182
About redundancy setup:
If current channel is not recording, current setup gets activated when the channel begin
recording the next time.
If current channel is recording now, current setup will get activated right away, the current file
will be packet and form a file, then system begins recording as you have just set.
After all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Figure 4-20
Playback or search in the redundant disk.
There are two ways for you to playback or search in the redundant disk.
Set redundant disk(s) as read-only disk or read-write disk (Main menu->Advanced->HDD
management). See Figure 4-20.System needs to reboot to get setup activated. Now you can
search or playback file in redundant disk.
Dismantle the disk and play it in another PC.
4.5.2 Snapshot
4.5.2.1 Schedule Snapshot
In Encode interface, click snapshot button to input snapshot mode, size, quality and
frequency. See the interface on the left of Figure 4-21.
Note:
The HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U series product and the HD-SDI 2U series product support 1080P,
720P, D1, HD1, 2CIF, CIF, QCIF resolution.
The 960H supports 960H, D1, HD1, 2CIF, CIF, QCIF resolution.
In FTP (Main Menu->Network->Network Setting) interface, please input upload interval. See
the interface in the middle of Figure 4-21.
In Schedule interface, please enable snapshot function. See interface on the right of Figure
4-21.
Please refer to the following figure for detailed information. See Figure 4-21.
183
Figure 4-21
4.5.2.2 Activation Snapshot
Please follow the steps listed below to enable the activation snapshot function. After you
enabled this function, system can snapshot when the corresponding alarm occurred.
In Encode interface, click snapshot button to input snapshot mode, size, quality and
frequency. See the interface on the left of Figure 4-22.
In FTP interface please input upload interval. See the interface in the middle of Figure
4-21.
In Detect interface please enable snapshot function for specified channels (interface in
the middle of Figure 4-22). Or in alarm interface (interface on the right of Figure 4-22)
please enable snapshot function for specified channels.
Please refer to the following figure for detailed information. See Figure 4-22.
184
Figure 4-22
4.5.2.3 Priority
Please note the activation snapshot has the higher priority than schedule snapshot. If you
have enabled these two types at the same time, system can activate the activation snapshot
when alarm occurs, and otherwise system just operates the schedule snapshot.
4.5.3 Image FTP
In Network interface, you can set FTP server information. Please enable FTP function and
then click save button. See Figure 4-23.
Please boot up corresponding FTP server.
Please enable schedule snapshot (Chapter 4.5.2.1) or activation snapshot (Chapter 4.5.2.2)
first, now system can upload the image file to the FTP server.
Please input the
corresponding information
here, if you just upload the
image FTP.
Figure 4-23
4.6 Detect
4.6.1 Go to Detect Menu
In the main menu, from Setting to Detect, you can see motion detect interface. See Figure
4-24.There is three detection types: motion detection, video loss, camera masking.
185
The video loss has no detection region and sensitivity setup and camera masking has no
detection region setup.
You can see motion detect icon if current channel has enabled motion detect alarm.
You can drag you mouse to set motion detect region without Fn button. Please click OK
button to save current region setup. Right click mouse to exit current interface.
4.6.2 Motion Detect
Detection menu is shown as below. See Figure 4-24
Event type: From the dropdown list you can select motion detection type.
Channel: Select a channel from the dropdown list to set motion detect function.
Enable: Check the box here to enable motion detect function.
Region: Click select button, the interface is shown as in Figure 4-25. Here you can set
motion detection zone. There are 396(PAL)/330(NTSC) small zones. Blue zone is the motion
detection zone. White zone is the disarmed zone. System can only detect motion detect
signal from the arm region. You can click Fn button to switch between the arm mode and
disarm mode. In arm mode, you can click the direction buttons to move the green rectangle
to set the motion detection zone. After you completed the setup, please click ENTER button
to exit current setup. Do remember click save button to save current setup. If you click ESC
button to exit the region setup interface system will not save your zone setup.
Sensitivity: System supports 6 levels. The sixth level has the highest sensitivity.
Period: Click set button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 4-27.Here you can
set motion detect period. System only enables motion detect operation in the specified
periods. It is not for video loss or the camera masking. Please select Sunday to Saturday
from the dropdown list. You can see there are six periods for you to set. Please note you
need to check the box before the period to enable the period setup valid. In Figure 4-27,
select work day or non-work day from the drop down list, and then click the Set button, you
can set your own business day and non-business day setup. See Figure 4-28. You can set
Monday to Friday as the working day and Saturday and Sunday as non-business day. Click
Save button to go back to previous interface.
Anti-dither: System only memorizes one event during the anti-dither period. The value
ranges from 5s to 600s.
Alarm output: when an alarm occurs, system enables peripheral alarm devices.
Latch: when motion detection complete, system auto delays detecting for a specified time.
The value ranges from 1-300(Unit: second)
Show message: System can pop up a message to alarm you in the local host screen if you
enabled this function.
Alarm upload: System can upload the alarm signal to the network (including alarm centre)
if you enabled current function.
Send email: System can send out email to alert you when alarm occurs.
Record channel: System auto activates motion detection channel(s) to record once an alarm
occurs. Please make sure you have set MD record in Schedule interface(Main Menu>Setting->Schedule) and schedule record in manual record interface(Main Menu>Advanced->Manual Record)
PTZ activation: Here you can set PTZ movement when an alarm occurs. Such as go to
preset, tour &pattern when there is an alarm. Click “select” button, you can see an interface
is shown as in Figure 4-26 .
X305H305H305H
X
186
Record Delay: System can delay the record for specified time after alarm ended. The value
ranges from 10s to 300s.
Tour: Here you can enable tour function when alarm occurs. System one-window tour.
Please go to chapter 5.3.9 Display for tour interval setup.
Snapshot: You can enable this function to snapshoot image when an motion detect alarm
occurs.
Buzzer: Highlight the icon to enable this function. The buzzer beeps when alarm occurs.
Test: Click it to test current motion detect setup (do not need to save). Click Select button
after Region, you can set motion detect area. The default setup is whole region. The blue
zones are the selected area. Please set sensitivity and click Test button, you can see system
only display motion detect status of the blue area. The red flashing area is current motion
detect. See Figure 4-30.
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function. After all the setups please click
Save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Note:
In motion detection mode, you can not use copy/paste to set channel setup since the video in
each channel may not be the same.
In Figure 4-25, you can left click mouse and then drag it to set a region for motion detection.
Click Fn to switch between arm/withdraw motion detection. After setting, click enter button to exit.
Figure 4-24
Figure 4-25
187
Figure 4-26
Figure 4-27
Figure 4-28
188
Figure 4-29
Figure 4-30
4.6.3 Video Loss
In Figure 4-24, select video loss from the type list. You can see the interface is shown as in
Figure 4-31.This function allows you to be informed when video loss phenomenon occurred.
You can enable alarm output channel and then enable show message function.
Tips:
You can enable preset/tour/pattern activation operation when video loss occurs.
Please refer to chapter 4.7 for local alarm setup information, except there is no device
type, anti-dither, video matrix function.
System only enables video loss function during the period you set here. It is null for
motion detect or camera masking type.
189
Figure 4-31
4.6.4 Camera Masking
When someone viciously masks the lens, or the output video is in one-color due to the
environments light change, the system can alert you to guarantee video continuity. Camera
masking interface is shown as in Figure 4-32. You can enable “Alarm output “or “Show
message” function when camera masking alarm occurs.
Sensitivity: The value ranges from 1 to 6. It mainly concerns the brightness. The level 6
has the higher sensitivity than level 1. The default setup is 3.
Tips:
You can enable preset/tour/pattern activation operation when video loss occurs.
Please refer to chapter 4.6.2 motion detection for detailed information.
Note:
In Detect interface, copy/paste function is only valid for the same type, which means you
can not copy a channel setup in video loss mode to camera masking mode.
About Default function. Since detection channel and detection type may not be the same,
system can only restore default setup of current detect type. For example, if you click
Default button at the camera masking interface, you can only restore default camera
masking setup. It is null for other detect types.
System only enables camera masking function during the period you set here. It is null
for motion detect or video loss type.
190
Figure 4-32
4.7 Alarm Setup and Alarm Activation
Before operation, please make sure you have properly connected alarm devices such as
buzzer.
4.7.1 Go to alarm setup interface
In the main menu, from Setting to Alarm, you can see alarm setup interface. See Figure 4-33.
4.7.2 Alarm setup
Alarm interface is shown as below. See Figure 4-33.
Alarm in: Here is for you to select channel number.
Event type: There are two types. One is local input and the other is network input.
Type: normal open or normal close.
PTZ activation: When an alarm occurred, system can activate the PTZ operation. The PTZ
activation lasts an anti-dither period.
In the Pan/Tilt/Zoom interface (Main menu->Setting-> Pan/Tilt/Zoom), please set video
channel, speed dome protocol and etc.
Select the channel of current speed dome as current monitor video and the right click
mouse to select Pan/Tilt/Zoom item. Now you can set preset, tour pattern.
In Figure 4-33, click “select” button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 4-34.
Here you can set the activation operation such as preset tour, pattern and enable.
Period: Click set button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 4-35. Here you can
set for business day and non-business day. In Figure 4-35, click set button, you can see an
interface is shown as in Figure 4-36. Here you can set your own setup for business day and
non-business day.
Anti-dither: Here you can set anti-dither time. The value ranges from 5 to 600s. The antidither time refers to the alarm signal lasts time. It can be seem as the alarm signal activation
stays such as the buzzer, tour, PTZ activation, snapshot, channel record. The stay time
191
here does not include the latch time. During the alarm process, the alarm signal can begin
an anti-dither time if system detects the local alarm again. The screen prompt, alarm upload,
email and etc will not be activated. For example, if you set the anti-dither time as 10 second,
you can see the each activation may last 10s if the local alarm is activated. During the
process, if system detects another local alarm signal at the fifth second, the buzzer, tour,
PTZ activation, snapshot, record channel will begin another 10s while the screen prompt,
alarm upload, email will not be activated again. After 10s, if system detects another alarm
signal, it can generate an alarm since the anti-dither time is out.
Show message: System can pop up a message to alarm you in the local host screen if you
enabled this function.
Alarm upload: System can upload the alarm signal to the network (including alarm centre)
if you enabled current function.
Send email: System can send out email to alert you when alarm occurs.
Record channel: you can select proper channel to record alarm video (Multiple choices).
You need to set alarm record mode as Schedule in Record interface (Main Menu>Advanced->Record). Please note the manual record has the highest priority. System
record all the time no matter there is an alarm or not if you select Manual mode.
Now you can go to the Schedule interface (Main Menu->Setting->Schedule) to set the
record type, corresponding channel number, week and date. You can select the record
type:Regular/MD/Alarm/MD&Alarm. Please note, you can not select the MD&Alarm and
MD(or Alarm) at the same time.
Now you can go to the Encode interface to select the alarm record and set the encode
parameter (Main Menu->Setting->Encode).
Finally, you can set the alarm input as the local alarm and then select the record
channel. The select channel begins alarm record when an alarm occurred. Please note
system begins the alarm record instead of the MD record if the local alarm and MD
event occurred at the same time.
Latch: When the anti-dither time ended, the channel alarm you select in the alarm output
may last the specified period. The value ranges from 1 to 300 seconds. This function is not
for other alarm activation operations. The latch is still valid even you disable the alarm event
function directly. .
Tour: Here you can enable tour function when alarm occurs. System supports one-window
tour. Please go to chapter 5.3.9 Display for tour interval setup.
Snapshot: You can enable this function to snapshoot image when an alarm occurs.
Video matrix: Check the box to enable this function. The video matrix output can display the
alarm video of current channel when there is an alarm signal.
Buzzer: Highlight the icon to enable this function. The buzzer beeps when alarm occurs.
Snapshot: For snapshot operation, please refer to chapter 4.5.2.
Note: The network alarm means the alarm signal from the TCP/IP. You can enable the network
alarm function via the net SDK. The network alarm does not have the device type; anti-dither and
alarm upload function. The rest items are the same.
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function. After setting all the setups
please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
192
Figure 4-33
Figure 4-34
Figure 4-35
193
Figure 4-36
4.8 Backup
DVR support USB device backup and network download. Here we introduce USB backup.
You can refer to Chapter 7 Web Client Operation for network download backup operation.
4.7.1 Detect Device
Click backup button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 4-37. Here is for you to
view devices information.
You can view backup device name and its total space and free space. The device includes
USB burner, flash disk, SD card, and portable HDD.
Figure 4-37
4.8.1 Backup
Select backup device and then set channel, file start time and end time.
Click add button, system begins search. All matched files are listed below. System
automatically calculates the capacity needed and remained. See Figure 4-38.
system only backup files with a √ before channel name. You can use Fn or cancel button to
delete √ after file serial number.
Click backup button, you can backup selected files. There is a process bar for you reference.
When the system completes backup, you can see a dialogue box prompting successful
backup.
194
Figure 4-38
Click backup button, system begins burning. At the same time, the backup button becomes
stop button. You can view the remaining time and process bar at the left bottom.
File format: Click the file format; you can see there are two options: DAV/ASF.
Picture backup: Please set the corresponding time, channel and then select the type as
PIC from the dropdown list. See Figure 4-39. Please click the Add button and then select
the pictures. Click the Start button; you can copy the specified pictures to the selected
portable devices.
Figure 4-39
One key backup: It includes three steps: the search, select all, start the backup. You can
skip the above three steps and then copy all the searched files directly.
The file name format usually is: Channel number+Record type+Time. In the file name, the
YDM format is Y+M+D+H+M+S. File extension name is .dav.
Tips:
During backup process, you can click ESC to exit current interface for other operation. The
system will not terminate backup process.
Note:
When you click stop button during the burning process, the stop function becomes activated
immediately. For example, if there are ten files, when you click stop system just backup five
files, system only save the previous 5 files in the device (But you can view ten file names).
4.9 PTZ Control and Color Setup
Note: All the operations here are based on PELCOD protocol. For other protocols, there
might be a little difference.
4.8.1 Cable Connection
195
Please follow the procedures below to go on cable connection
Connect the dome RS485 port to DVR 485 port.
Connect dome video output cable to DVR video input port.
Connect power adapter to the dome.
4.8.2 PTZ Setup
Note: The camera video should be in the current screen. Before setup, please check the
following connections are right:
PTZ and decoder connection is right. Decoder address setup is right.
Decoder A (B) line connects with DVR A (B) line.
Boot up the DVR, input user name and password.
In the main menu, click setting, and then click Pan/Tilt Control button. The interface is shown
as in Figure 4-40. Here you can set the following items:
Channel: select the current camera channel.
Protocol: select corresponding PTZ protocol(such as PELCOD)
Address: default address is 1.
Baud rate: select corresponding baud rate. Default value is 9600.
Data bits: select corresponding data bits. Default value is 8.
Stop bits: select corresponding stop bits. Default value is 1.
Parity: there are three options: odd/even/none. Default setup is none.
Figure 4-40
After completing all the setting please click save button. Right click mouse (click “Fn” Button
in the front panel or click “Fn” key in the remote control). The interface is shown as in Figure
4-41.
196
Figure 4-41
Click Pan/Tilt/Zoom, the interface is shown as below. See Figure 4-42.
Here you can set the following items:
Step: value ranges fro 1 to 8.
Zoom
Focus
Iris
Please click icon
and
to adjust zoom, focus and iris.
Figure 4-42
In Figure 4-42, please click direction arrows (See Figure 4-43) to adjust PTZ position. There are
total 8 direction arrows.
Figure 4-43
4.8.3 3D Intelligent Positioning Key
In the middle of the eight direction arrows, there is a 3D intelligent positioning key. SeeFigure
4-44. Please make sure your protocol supports this function and you need to use mouse to
control.
X
197
Click this key, system goes back to the single screen mode. Drag the mouse in the screen to
adjust section size. The dragged zone supports 4X to 16X speeds. It can realize PTZ
automatically. The smaller zone you dragged, the higher the speed.
Figure 4-44
Here is a sheet for you reference.
Name
Function
function
key
Zoom
Near
Focus
Near
Iris
close
Shortcut
key
│
⊳
Function
key
function
Far
Far
Open
Shortcut
Key
►│
4.10 Preset/
Preset/ Patrol/P
atrol/Pattern
/Pattern/Scan
attern/Scan
In Figure 4-42, please click the “set” button. The interface is shown as below. See Figure 4-45.
Here you can set the following items:
Preset
Tour
Pattern
Border
Figure 4-45
In Figure 4-42, click page switch button, the interface is shown as in Figure 4-46.
Here you can activate the following functions:
Preset
Tour
Pattern
Auto scan
Auto pan
Flip
Reset
Page switch
X328H328H 328H
198
Figure 4-46
Note:
Preset, tour and pattern all need the value to be the control parameter. You can define it as
you require.
You need to refer to your speed dome user’s manual for Aux definition. In some cases, it
can be used for special process.
The following setups are usually operated in the Figure 4-42, Figure 4-45 and Figure 4-46.
X332H332H332H
4.9.1Preset Setup
In Figure 4-42, use eight direction arrows to adjust camera to the proper position.
In Figure 4-45, click preset button and input preset number. The interface is shown as in Figure
4-47.
Now you can add this preset to one tour.
Figure 4-47
4.9.2 Activate Preset
In Figure 4-46, please input preset number in the No. blank, and click preset button.
4.9.3 Patrol setup (Tour Setup)
In Figure 4-38, click patrol button. The interface is shown as in Figure 4-48.Input preset number
and add this preset to a patrol (tour). For each patrol (tour), you can input max 80 presets.
Figure 4-48
199
4.9.4 Activate Patrol (tour)
In
X341H341H 341H
Figure 4-45, input patrol (tour) number in the No. blank and click patrol button
4.9.5 Pattern Setup
In Figure 4-45, click pattern button and then click “begin” button. The interface is shown as in
Figure 4-49. Then you can go to Figure 4-42 X to modify zoom, focus, and iris.
Go back to Figure 4-49 and click “end” button. You can memorize all these operations as pattern
1.
Figure 4-49
4.9.6 Activate Pattern Function
In
X346H346H 346H
Figure 4-39, input mode value in the No. blank, and click pattern button.
4.9.7 Auto Scan Setup
In Figure 4-38, click border button. The interface is shown as in Figure 4-43.
Figure 4-35, use direction arrows to select camera left limit
Please go to
Then please go to Figure 4-43 and click left limit button
Repeat the above procedures to set right limit.
X347H347H 347H
X348H348H348H
X349H349H349H
X349H3 49H349H
X350H350H350H
X
Figure 4-50
4.9.8 Activate Auto Scan
In Figure 4-46, click “Auto Scan” button, the system begins auto scan. Correspondingly, the auto
scan button becomes Stop button. Click stop button to terminate scan operation.
4.11 Flip
In Figure 4-46, click page switch button, you can see an interface is shown as below. See Figure
4-51. Here you can set auxiliary function. The aux value has relation ship with the Aux button of
the decoder.
Click page switch button again, system goes back to Figure 4-42.
200
Figure 4-51
201
5 Understanding
Understanding of Menu Operations and Controls
5.1 Menu Tree
This series DVR menu tree is shown as below.
Backup
Information
HDD Info
BPS
Log
Version
Online Users
Network Info
Setting
General
Encode
Schedule
RS232
Network
Alarm
Detect
Pan/ Tilt/Zoom
Display
Default
Menu
Search
Advanced
HDD Management
Alarm Output
Abnormality
Manual Record
Account
Auto Maintain
TV Adjust
Video Matrix
Title Overlay
Config Backup
Shutdown
5.2 Main Menu
After you logged in, the system main menu is shown as below. See Figure 5-1. There are total
six icons: search, Information, setting, backup, advanced and shutdown. Move the cursor to
highlight the icon, then double click mouse to enter the sub-menu.
X
202
Figure 5-1
5.3 Setting
In main menu, highlight setting icon and double click mouse. System setting interface is shown
as below. See Figure 5-2.
Figure 5-2
5.3.1 General
General setting includes the following items. See Figure 5-3 .
System time: Here is for you to set system time
Date format: There are three types: YYYYY-MM-DD: MM-DD-YYYYY or DD-MM-YYYY.
Date separator: There are three denotations to separate date: dot, beeline and solidus.
DST: Here you can set DST time and date. Please enable DST function and then click set
button. You can see an interface is shown as in Figure 5-4. Here you can set start time and
end time by setting corresponding week setup. In Figure 5-4, enable date button, you can
see an interface is shown as in Figure 5-5. Here you can set start time and end time by
setting corresponding date setup.
Time format: There are two types: 24-hour mode or 12-hour mode.
Language: System supports various languages: Chinese (simplified), Chinese (Traditional),
English, Italian, Japanese, French, Spanish (All languages listed here are optional. Slight
difference maybe found in various series.)
HDD full: Here is for you to select working mode when hard disk is full. There are two options:
stop recording or rewrite. If current working HDD is overwritten or the current HDD is full
X357H357H357H
X
203
while the next HDD is no empty, then system stops recording, If the current HDD is full and
then next HDD is not empty, then system overwrites the previous files.
Video standard: There are two formats: NTSC and PAL.
Pack duration: Here is for you to specify record duration. The value ranges from 1 to 120
minutes. Default value is 60 minutes.
Real-time playback: It is to set playback time you can view in the preview interface (chapter
4.2 Live Viewing). The value ranges from 5 to 60 minutes.
Device ID: Please input a corresponding device name here.
Holiday setup: Click it you can see an interface shown as in Figure 5-7. Here you can set
holiday date. Please go to chapter 4.5 Schedule to view or set the holiday date record setup.
When you enable Holiday settings and schedule setup at the same time, holiday setting
has the priority. If the selected day is a holiday, then system records as you set in
holiday setting. If it is not a holiday, system records as you set in Schedule interface.
Please note you need to go to chapter 4.5 Schedule to enable Holiday setup. Otherwise
you can not enable holiday record setup.
Please note, there is no year setup on the holiday setup. For example, if you set 30th
Oct, 2012 as a holiday, then the date of 30th Oct in each year will be set as a holiday.
So, general speaking, your holiday setup in other year may also affect the holiday setup
in 2012.
Auto logout: Here is for you to set auto logout interval once login user remains inactive for a
specified time. Value ranges from 0 to 60 minutes.
Mouse property: Click mouse setup button, you can go to mouse setup interface. See Figure
5-7. You can set double click speed via dragging the slide bard. You can Click Default button
to restore default setup.
Startup wizard: Check the box here, system goes to the startup wizard when the device
boots up the next time. Otherwise, it goes to the system login interface directly.
Navigation bar: Check the box here, system displays the navigation bar on the interface.
Note:
Since system time is very important, do not modify time casually unless there is a must!
Before your time modification, please stop record operation first!
After completing all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
204
Figure 5-3
Figure 5-4
Figure 5-5
Figure 5-6
205
Figure 5-7
5.3.2 Encode
Encode setting includes the following items. See Figure 5-8.
Please note some series do not support extra stream.
Channel: Select the channel you want.
Type: Please select from the dropdown list. There are three options: regular/motion
detect/alarm. You can set the various encode parameters for different record types.
Compression: System supports H.264.
Resolution: System supports various resolutions, you can select from the dropdown list. The
main stream supports D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF and the extra stream supports CIF/QCIF.
Please note the option may vary due to different series.
Note:
a). For HD-SDI series, the main code-stream types are
1080P/720P/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF; Extra stream resolution supports D1/CIF/QCIF.
b). For 960H series, the main code-stream types are 960H/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF;
Extra stream resolution supports 960H/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF.
Frame rate: It ranges from 1f/s to 25f/s in NTSC mode and 1f/s to 30f/s in PAL mode.
Note:
For the 16-channel series product of the HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U series product and the HDSDI 1080P 2U series product, when the main stream resolution is 1080P, the frame rate
of the 1/5/9/13-channel max supports 25f/s or 30f/s and the frame rate of the rest
channels support 12f/s or 15f/s. The extras stream of the HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U series
product and the HD-SDI 1080P 2U series product support D1 (6fps or 7f/s.)
Bit rate type: System supports two types: CBR and VBR. In VBR mode, you can set video
quality.
Quality: There are six levels ranging from 1 to 6. The sixth level has the highest image
quality.
Video/audio: You can enable or disable the video/audio.
Overlay: Click overlay button, you can see an interface is shown in Figure 5-9.
Cover area (Privacy mask): Here is for you to set privacy mask section. You can drag you
mouse to set proper section size. In one channel video, system max supports 4 zones in one
channel.
Preview/monitor: privacy mask has two types. Preview and Monitor. Preview means the
privacy mask zone can not be viewed by user when system is in preview status. Monitor
means the privacy mask zone can not be view by the user when system is in monitor status.
206
Time display: You can select system displays time or not when you playback. Please click
set button and then drag the title to the corresponding position in the screen.
Channel display: You can select system displays channel number or not when you playback.
Please click set button and then drag the title to the corresponding position in the screen.
Copy:After you complete the setup, you can click Copy button to copy current setup to
other channel(s). You can see an interface is shown as in Figure 5-10. You can see current
channel number is grey. Please check the number to select the channel or you can check
the box ALL. Please click the OK button in Figure 5-10 and Figure 5-8 respectively to
complete the setup. Please note, once you check the All box, you set same encode setup for
all channels. Audio/video enable box, overlay button and the copy button is shield. See
Figure 5-11.
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function.
Figure 5-8
Figure 5-9
207
Figure 5-10
Figure 5-11
5.3.3 Schedule
Please refer to chapter 4.5 schedule.
5.3.4 RS232
RS232 interface is shown as below. There are five items. See Figure 5-12.
Function: There are various devices for you to select. Console is for you to use the COM or
mini-end software to upgrade or debug the program. The control keyboard is for you to
control the device via the special keyboard. Transparent COM (adapter) is to connect to the
PC to transfer data directly. Protocol COM is for card overlay function. Network keyboard is
for you to use the special keyboard to control the device. PTZ matrix is to connect to the
peripheral matrix control.
Baud rate: You can select proper baud rate.
Data bit: You can select proper data bit. The value ranges from 5 to 8.
Stop bit: There are three values: 1/1.5/2.
Parity: there are five choices: none/odd/even/space mark.
System default setup is:
Function: Console
Baud rate:115200
Data bit:8
208
Stop bit:1
Parity: None
After completing all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Figure 5-12
5.3.5 Network
Here is for you to input network information.
The single network adapter interface is shown as in Figure 5-13 and the dual network adapters
interface (for some series product only) is shown as in Figure 5-14.
IP Version: There are two options: IPv4 and IPv6. Right now, system supports these two IP
address format and you can access via them.
MAC address: The host in the LAN can get a unique MAC address. It is for you to access in the
LAN. It is read-only.
IP address: Here you can use up/down button () or input the corresponding number to
input IP address. Then you can set the corresponding subnet mask the default gateway.
Subnet prefix: The input value ranges from 0 to 128. It is to mark a specified network MAC
address. Usually it includes an organization of multiple-level.
Default gateway: Here you can input the default gateway. Please note system needs to
check the validity of all IPv6 addresses. The IP address and the default gateway shall
be in the same IP section. That is to say, the specified length of the subnet prefix shall
have the same string.
DHCP: It is to auto search IP. When enable DHCP function, you can not modify IP/Subnet
mask /Gateway. These values are from DHCP function. If you have not enabled DHCP
function, IP/Subnet mask/Gateway display as zero. You need to disable DHCP function to
view current IP information. Besides, when PPPoE is operating, you can not modify
IP/Subnet mask /Gateway.
TCP port: Default value is 37777. You can change if necessary.
UDP port: Default value is 37778. You can change if necessary.
HTTP port: Default value is 80.
HTTPS port: Default value is 443.
RTSP port: Default value is 554.
Important: System needs to reboot after you changed and saved any setup of the above
four ports. Please make sure the port values here do not conflict.
209
Max connection: system support maximal 128 users. 0 means there is no connection limit.
MTU: It is to set MTU value of the network adapter. The value ranges from 1280-7200 bytes.
The default setup is 1500 bytes. Please note MTU modification may result in network
adapter reboot and network becomes off. That is to say, MTU modification can affect current
network service. System may pop up dialog box for you to confirm setup when you want to
change MTU setup. Click OK button to confirm current reboot, or you can click Cancel button
to terminate current modification. Before the modification, you can check the MTU of the
gateway; the MTU of the DVR shall be the same as or is lower than the MTU of the gateway.
In this way, you can reduce packets and enhance network transmission efficiency.
The following MTU value is for reference only.
1500: Ethernet information packet max value and it is also the default value. It is the
typical setup when there is no PPPoE or VPN. It is the default setup of some router,
switch or the network adapter.
1492: Recommend value for PPPoE.
1468: Recommend value for DHCP.
Preferred DNS server: DNS server IP address.
Alternate DNS server: DNS server alternate address.
Transfer mode: Here you can select the priority between fluency/video qualities.
LAN download: System can process the downloaded data first if you enable this function.
The download speed is 1.5X or 2.0X of the normal speed.
Dual network adapters mode:
Multiple-address mode: eth0 and eth1 operate separately. You can use the services
such as HTTP, RTP service via etho0 or the eth1 usually you need to set one default
card(default setup is etho) to request the auto network service form the device-end such
as DHCP, email ,FTP and etc. In multiple-address mode, system network status is
shown as offline once one card is offline.
Network fault-tolerance: In this mode, device uses bond0 to communicate with the
external devices. You can focus on one host IP address. At the same time, you need to
set one master card. Usually there is only one running card (master card).System can
enable alternate card when the master card is malfunction. The system is shown as
offline once these two cards are both offline. Please note these two cards shall be in the
same LAN.
Load balance: In this mode, device uses bond0 to communicate with the external device.
The eth0 and eth1 are both working now and bearing the network load. Their network
load are general the same. The system is shown as offline once these two cards are
both offline. Please note these two cards shall be in the same LAN.
Important
For the IP address of IPv6 version, default gateway, preferred DNS and alternate DNS, the
input value shall be 128-digit. It shall not be left in blank.
After completing all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
210
Figure 5-13
Figure 5-14
5.3.5.1 Network Setting
Network setting interface is shown as in Figure 5-15. Please check the box to enable
corresponding function and then double click current item to go to setup interface.
Figure 5-15
5.3.5.2 IP Filter
211
IP filter interface is shown as in Figure 5-16. You can add IP in the following list. The list supports
max 64 IP addresses. System supports valid address of IPv4 and IPv6. Please note system
needs to check the validity of all IPv6 addresses.
After you enabled trusted sites function, only the IP listed below can access current DVR.
If you enable blocked sites function, the following listed IP addresses can not access current
DVR.
Enable: Highlight the box here, you can check the trusted site function and blocked sites
function. You can not see these two modes if the Enable button is grey.
Type: You can select trusted site and blacklist from the dropdown list. You can view the IP
address on the following column.
Start address/end address: Select one type from the dropdown list, you can input IP address
in the start address and end address. Now you can click Add IP address or Add IP section to
add.
a) For the newly added IP address, it is in enable status by default. Remove the √ before
the item, and then current item is not in the list.
b) System max supports 64 items.
c) Address column supports IPv4 or IPv6 format. If it is IPv6 address, system can optimize
it. For example, system can optimize aa:0000: 00: 00aa: 00aa: 00aa: 00aa: 00aa as aa::
aa: aa: aa: aa: aa: aa.
d) System automatically removes space if there is any space before or after the newly
added IP address.
e) System only checks start address if you add IP address. System check start address
and end address if you add IP section and the end address shall be larger than the start
address.
f) System may check newly added IP address exists or not. System does not add if input
IP address does not exist.
Delete: Click it to remove specified item.
Edit: Click it to edit start address and end address. See Figure 5-18. System can check the
IP address validity after the edit operation and implement IPv6 optimization.
Default: Click it to restore default setup. In this case, the trusted sites and blocked sites are
both null.
Note:
If you enabled trusted sites, only the IP in the trusted sites list can access the device.
If you enabled blocked sites, the IP in the blocked sites can not access the device.
System supports add MAC address.
212
Figure 5-16
Figure 5-17
Figure 5-18
5.3.5.3 NTP Setup
213
You need to install SNTP server (Such as Absolute Time Server) in your PC first. In Windows XP
OS, you can use command “net start w32time” to boot up NTP service.
NTP setup interface is shown as in Figure 5-19.
Host IP: Input your PC address.
Port: This series DVR supports TCP transmission only. Port default value is 123.
Update interval: minimum value is 1. Max value is 65535. (Unit: minute)
Time zone: select your corresponding time zone here.
Manual update: It allows you to synchronize the time with the server manually.
Here is a sheet for your time zone setup.
City /Region Name
Time Zone
London
GMT+0
Berlin
GMT+1
Cairo
GMT+2
Moscow
GMT+3
New Deli
GMT+5
Bangkok
GMT+7
Beijing (Hong Kong)
GMT+8
Tokyo
GMT+9
Sydney
GMT+10
Hawaii
GMT-10
Alaska
GMT-9
Pacific Time(P.T)
GMT-8
American Mountain Time(M.T)
GMT-7
American Central Time(C.T)
GMT-6
American Eastern Time(E.T)
GMT-5
Atlantic Time
GMT-4
Brazil
GMT-3
Middle Atlantic Time
GMT-2
Figure 5-19
5.3.5.4 Multiple Cast Setup
Multiple-cast setup interface is shown as in Figure 5-20.
214
Figure 5-20
Here you can set a multiple cast group. Please refer to the following sheet for detailed
information.
IP multiple cast group address
-224.0.0.0-239.255.255.255
-“D” address space
The higher four-bit of the first byte=”1110”
Reserved local multiple cast group address
-224.0.0.0-224.0.0.255
-TTL=1 When sending out telegraph
-For example
224.0.0.1 All systems in the sub-net
224.0.0.2 All routers in the sub-net
224.0.0.4 DVMRP router
224.0.0.5 OSPF router
224.0.0.13 PIMv2 router
Administrative scoped addressees
-239.0.0.0-239.255.255.255
-Private address space
Like the single broadcast address of RFC1918
Can not be used in Internet transmission
Used for multiple cast broadcast in limited space.
Except the above mentioned addresses of special meaning, you can use other addresses. For
example:
Multiple cast IP: 235.8.8.36
Multiple cast PORT: 3666.
After you logged in the Web, the Web can automatically get multiple cast address and add it to
the multiple cast groups. You can enable real-time monitor function to view the view.
Please note multiple cast function applies to special series only.
5.3.5.5 PPPoE
PPPoE interface is shown as in Figure 5-21.
Input “PPPoE name” and “PPPoE password” you get from your ISP (Internet service provider).
Click save button, you need to restart to activate your configuration.
After rebooting, DVR will connect to internet automatically. The IP in the PPPoE is the DVR
dynamic value. You can access this IP to visit the unit.
215
Figure 5-21
5.3.5.6 DDNS Setup
DDNS setup interface is shown as in Figure 5-22.
You need a PC of fixed IP in the internet and there is the DDNS software running in this PC. In
other words, this PC is a DNS (domain name server).
In network DDNS, please select DDNS type and highlight enable item. Them please input your
PPPoE name you get from you IPS and server IP (PC with DDNS ) . Click save button and then
reboot system.
Click save button, system prompts for rebooting to get all setup activated.
After rebooting, open IE and input as below:
http://(DDNS server IP)/(virtual directory name)/webtest.htm
e.g.: http://10.6.2.85/DVR _DDNS/webtest.htm.)
Now you can open DDNSServer web search page.
Figure 5-22
Please note NNDS type includes: CN99 DDNS, NO-IP DDNS, Quick DDNS and Dyndns DDNS.
All the DDNS can be valid at the same time, you can select as you requirement.
Quick DDNS function shall work with special DDNS server and special Professional Surveillance
Software (PSS).
216
Quick DDNS and Client-end Introduction
1) Background Introduction
Device IP is not fixed if you use ADSL to login the network. The DDNS function allows you to
access the DVR via the registered domain name. Besides the general DDNS, the Quick DDNS
works with the device from the manufacturer so that it can add the extension function.
2) Function Introduction
The quick DDNS client has the same function as other DDNS client end. It realizes the bonding
of the domain name and the IP address. Right now, current DDNS server is for our own devices
only. You need to refresh the bonding relationship of the domain and the IP regularly. There is no
user name, password or the ID registration on the server. At the same time, each device has a
default domain name (Generated by MAC address) for your option. You can also use customized
valid domain name (has not registered.).
3) Operation
Before you use Quick DDNS, you need to enable this service and set proper server address, port
value and domain name.
Server address:www.quickddns.com
Port number:80
Domain name:There are two modes: Default domain name and customized domain name.
Except default domain name registration, you can also use customized domain name (You can
input your self-defined domain name.) After successful registration, you can use domain name
to login installed of the device IP.
User name: It is optional. You can input your commonly used email address.
Important
Do not register frequently. The interval between two registrations shall be more than 60
seconds. Too many registration requests may result in server attack.
System may take back the domain name that is idle for one year. You can get a notification
email before the cancel operation if your email address setup is OK.
5.3.5.7 UPNP
The UPNP protocol is to establish a mapping relationship between the LAN and the WAN.
Please input the router IP address in the LAN in Figure 5-14. Double click the UPNP item in
Figure 5-15, you can see the following interface. See Figure 5-23.
UPNP on/off :Turn on or off the UPNP function of the device.
Status: When the UPNP is offline, it shows as “Unknown”. When the UPNP works it shows
“Success”
Router LAN IP: It is the router IP in the LAN.
WAN IP: It is the router IP in the WAN.
Port Mapping list: The port mapping list here is the one to one relationship with the router’s
port mapping setting.
Enable Switch
List:
: :It shows that the function of port mapping is enabled in this port.
Service name:Defined by user.
Protocol: Protocol type
Internal port:Port that has been mapped in the router.
217
External port:Port that has been mapped locally.
Default: UPNP default port setting is the HTTP, TCP and UDP of the DVR.
Add to the list: Click it to add the mapping relationship.
Delete: Click it to remove one mapping item.
Double click one item; you can change the corresponding mapping information. See Figure 5-24.
Important:
When you are setting the router external port, please use 1024~5000 port. Do not use wellknown port 1~255 and the system port 256~1023 to avoid conflict.
For the TCP and UDP, please make sure the internal port and external port are the same to
guarantee the proper data transmission.
Figure 5-23
Figure 5-24
5.3.5.8 WIFI
You can view the WIFI connection status in the Network Setting interface. See Figure 5-25.
You can view current connection status and IP address if there is a connection.
218
Figure 5-25
The WIFI interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-26.
Auto connect WIFI: Check the box here, system automatically connects to the previous WIFI
hotspot.
Refresh: You can click it to search the hotspot list again. It can automatically add the
information such as the password if you have set it before.
Disconnect: Here you can click it to turn off the connection.
Connect: Here you can click it to connect to the hotspot. System needs to turn off current
connection and then connect to a new hotspot if there is connection of you selected one.
See Figure 5-27.
Figure 5-26
219
Figure 5-27
After successfully connection, you can see the following interface. You can see it is connected
now. See Figure 5-27.
Figure 5-28
WIFI working status: Here you can view current connection status.
Please note:
After successful connection, you can see WIFI connection icon at the top right corner of the
preview interface.
When the hotspot verification type is WEP, system displays as AUTO since the device can
not detect its encryption type.
System does not support verification type WPA and WPA2. The display may become
abnormal for the verification type and encryption type.
After device successfully connected to the WIFI, you can view the hotspot name, IP address,
subnet mask, default gateway and etc. See Figure 5-29.
220
Figure 5-29
5.3.5.9 Email
The email interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-30.
SMTP server: Please input your email SMTP server IP here.
Port: Please input corresponding port value here.
User name: Please input the user name to login the sender email box.
Password: Please input the corresponding password here.
Sender: Please input sender email box here.
Title: Please input email subject here. System support English character and Arabic number.
Max 32-digit.
Receiver: Please input receiver email address here. System max supports 3 email boxes.
System automatically filters same addresses if you input one receiver repeatedly.
SSL enable: System supports SSL encryption box.
Interval: The send interval ranges from 0 to 3600 seconds. 0 means there is no interval.
Health email enable: Please check the box here to enable this function. This function allows
the system to send out the test email to check the connection is OK or not.
Interval: Please check the above box to enable this function and then set the corresponding
interval. System can send out the email regularly as you set here. Click the Test button, you
can see the corresponding dialogue box to see the email connection is OK or not. See
Figure 5-31.
Please note system will not send out the email immediately when the alarm occurs. When the
alarm, motion detection or the abnormity event activates the email, system sends out the email
according to the interval you specified here. This function is very useful when there are too many
emails activated by the abnormity events, which may result in heavy load for the email server.
221
Figure 5-30
Figure 5-31
5.3.5.10 FTP
You need to download or buy FTP service tool (such as Ser-U FTP SERVER) to establish FTP
service.
Please install Ser-U FTP SERVER first. From “start” -> “program” -> Serv-U FTP Server -> ServU Administator. Now you can set user password and FTP folder. Please note you need to grant
write right to FTP upload user. See Figure 5-32.
222
Figure 5-32
You can use a PC or FTP login tool to test setup is right or not.
For example, you can login user ZHY to FTP://10.10.7.7 and then test it can modify or delete
folder or not. See Figure 5-33.
H140H140H1 40HTU
UTH
Figure 5-33
System also supports upload multiple DVRs to one FTP server. You can create multiple folders
under this FTP.
In Figure 5-239, select FTP and then double click mouse. You can see the following interface.
See Figure 5-34.
Please highlight the icon
Here you can input FTP server address, port and remote directory. When remote directory is
null, system automatically create folders according to the IP, time and channel.
User name and password is the account information for you to login the FTP.
Now you can set upload file length, picture upload interval, upload file channel, time and
type.
File length is upload file length. When setup is larger than the actual file length, system
will upload the whole file. When setup here is smaller than the actual file length, system
only uploads the set length and auto ignore the left section. When interval value is 0,
system uploads all corresponding files.
At the same time, you can set two periods, three record files for different channels.
in front of Enable to activate FTP function.
223
Click the Test button, you can see the corresponding dialogue box to see the FTP
connection is OK or not. See Figure 5-35.
Figure 5-34
Figure 5-35
5.3.5.11 Alarm Centre
This interface is reserved for you to develop.
5.3.5.12 SNMP
SNMP is an abbreviation of Simple Network Management Protocol. It provides the basic network
management frame of the network management system. The SNMP widely used in many
environments. It is used in many network device, software and system.
You can set in the following interface. See Figure 5-36.
224
Figure 5-36
Please enable the SNMP function. Use the corresponding software tool (MIB Builder and MGSOFT MIB Browser. You still need two MIB file: BASE-SNMP-MIB, DVR-SNMP-MIB) to connect
to the device. You can get the device corresponding configuration information after successfully
connection.
Please follow the steps listed below to configure.
In Figure 5-36, check the box to enable the SNMP function. Input the IP address of the PC
than is running the software in the Trap address. You can use default setup for the rest
items.
Compile the above mentioned two MIB file via the software MIB Builder.
Run MG-SOFT MIB Browser to load the file from the previous step to the software.
Input the device IP you want to manage in the MG-SOFT MIB Browser. Please set the
corresponding version for your future reference.
Open the tree list on the MG-SOFT MIB Browser; you can get the device configuration. Here
you can see the device has how many video channels, audio channels, application version
and etc.
Note
Port conflict occurs when SNMP port and Trap port are the same.
5.3.5.13 Network Priority
This interface is for you to set network priority. The default setup is PPPoE>WIFI>3G>LAN. See
Figure 5-37. You can change if necessary.
Default gateway: It is to display current default gateway. It is to display PPPoE if PPPoE dial
succeeded.
Priority: The value ranges from 0 to 3. 0 has the highest priority.
Name: It is to display network name. Use
/
to move current item up/down.
Note:
PPPoE always has the highest priority. You can change the priority of the rest three items.
225
Figure 5-37
5.3.5.14 Auto register
This function allows the device to auto register to the proxy you specified. In this way, you can
use the client-end to access the DVR and etc via the proxy. Here the proxy has a switch function.
In the network service, device supports the server address of IPv4 or domain.
Please follow the steps listed below to use this function.
Please set proxy server address, port, and sub-device name at the device-end. Please enable
the auto register function, the device can auto register to the proxy server.
1) The setup interface is shown as in Figure 5-38.
Important
Do not input network default port such as TCP port number.
Figure 5-38
2) The proxy server software developed from the SDK. Please open the software and input the
global setup. Please make sure the auto connection port here is the same as the port you set in
the previous step.
3) Now you can add device. Please do not input default port number such as the TCP port in the
mapping port number. The device ID here shall be the same with the ID you input in Figure 5-38.
Click Add button to complete the setup.
226
4) Now you can boot up the proxy server. When you see the network status is Y, it means your
registration is OK. You can view the proxy server when the device is online.
Important
The server IP address can also be domain. But you need to register a domain name before you
run proxy device server.
5.3.6 Alarm
Please refer to chapter 4.7 Alarm Setup and Activation.
5.3.7 Detect
Please refer to chapter 4.6 Detect.
5.3.8 Pan/Tilt/Zoom
The pan/tilt/zoom setup includes the following items. Please select channel first. See Figure 5-39.
Protocol: Select corresponding PTZ protocol such as PELCOD.
Address: input corresponding PTZ address.
Baud rate: Select baud rate.
Data bit: Select data bit.
Stop bit: Select stop bit.
Parity: There are three choices: none/odd/even.
After completed all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
For detailed setup, please refer to chapter 4.10 preset/patrol/pattern/scan.
Figure 5-39
5.3.9 Display
Display setup interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-43.
Transparency: Here is for you to adjust transparency. The value ranges from 128 to 255.
Channel name: Here is for you to modify channel name. System max support 25-digit (The
value may vary due to different series). Please note all your modification here only applies to
DVR local end. You need to open web or client end to refresh channel name.
Time display: You can select to display time or not when system is playback.
Channel display: You can select to channel name or not when system is playback.
227
Resolution: There are four options: 1920×1080, 1280×1024(default),1280×720,1024×768.
Please note the system needs to reboot to activate current setup.
Image enhance: Check the box; you can optimize the margin of the preview video.
Tour setup: Here you can activate tour function. Click Setup button, you can see an interface
shown as in Figure 5-45.
Enable tour: Highlight box here to enable this function.
Interval: System supports 1/4/8/9/16-window tour. Input proper interval value here. The
value ranges from 5-120 seconds. It is for schedule tour/alarm/motion detect tour.
Split: You can select window split mode from the dropdown list.
Channel group: It is for you to view channel names under current window split mode.
You can add/delete channel here. Double click one item, you can change channel group
setup to edit it. Now system max supports 32 channels.
Add: Under specified window split mode, click it to add channel group.
Delete: Click it to remove selected channel group.
Move up: Click it to move current selected channel up.
Move down: Click it to move current selected channel down.
Default: Click it to restore default setup.
Favorites: It is for you to set and save favorites preview setup. You can select different
wiindow display modes and then select corresponding channel(s). Please note for one mode,
one channel can only be selected once. Click Setup button, you can see an interface shown
as in Figure 5-40.
Current setup: Click it yo get channel setup information of current preview interface. For
example. If you window split mode is 4 and channel setup includes channel 1/2/3/4, you
can see 4 from the split dropdown list and then see channel 1/2/3/4 at the middle of the
interface.
View now: Click it to activate current setup. You can see current setup effect on the
screen right now.
Defualt: it is to restore factory default setup. For example, 1-window mode, it is to
display channel 1 and 4-window mode, it is display channel 1/2/3/4.
Save: Click it to save current setup to Favorites folder. Otherwise, you can not find
current setup in the Favorites.
Figure 5-40
228
On the navigation bar, you can see the Favorites shortcut menu. You can select from the
dropdown list. Click View 1, you can see the channel(s) you saved on the Favorites folder. See
Figure 5-41.
Figure 5-41
Zero-Channel Encoding: Click Setup button, you can go to the following interface. Figure
5-42. Here you can enable and set zero-channel encoding function so that you can view
several video sources at one channel.
Enable: This function is disabled by default. Check the box here to enable this function
so that you can control the zero-channel encoding function at the WEB.
Compression: System default setup is H.264. You can set according to device capability.
Resolution: The resolution value may vary due to different device capabilities. Please
select from the dropdown list.
Frame rate: The frame rate value may vary due to different device capabilities. Please
select from the dropdown list.
Bit Rate: The bit rate value may vary due to different device capabilities and frame rate
setups. Please select from the dropdown list.
Save: Click the Save button to save current setup. If this function is disabled, you can
not operate zero-channel encoding function at the WEB, the video is black or null even
you operate when the function is disabled. After you enabled this function, login the
Web and you can select zero-channel encoding mode at the right corner of the
interface
. Select a mode; you can view the local preview video.
Figure 5-42
229
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function.
After completing all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Figure 5-43
In Figure 5-43, click modify button after channel. You can see an interface is shown as in Figure
5-44. Please note all your modification here applies to local end only. You need to refresh web or
client-end to get the latest channel name. System max support 25-digital character.
Figure 5-44
230
Figure 5-45
5.3.10 Default
Click default icon, system pops up a dialogue box. You can highlight
to restore default factory
setup. See Figure 5-26.
Select all
General
Encode
Schedule
RS232
Network
Alarm
Detect
Pan/tilt/zoom
Display
Channel name
X381H381H381H
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function.
After all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Warning!
System menu color, language, time display mode, video format, IP address, user account will not
maintain previous setup after default operation!
231
Figure 5-46
5.4 Search
Please refer to chapter 4.4 Search.
5.5 Advanced
Double click advanced icon in the main window, the interface is shown as below. See Figure
5-47.There are total ten function keys: HDD management, alarm output, abnormity, manual
record, account, auto maintenance, TV adjust and video matrix.
Figure 5-47
5.5.1 HDD Management
Here is for you to view and implement hard disk management. See Figure 5-48.
You can see current HDD type, status, capacity and record time. When HDD is working properly,
system is shown as O. When HDD error occurred, system is shown as X.
232
Alarm set: Click alarm set button, the interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-49. (This
interface is just like the abnormity setup). Please refer to chapter 5.5.2 for detailed
information.
HDD operation: You can select HDD mode from the dropdown list such as read-only or you
can erase all data in the HDD. Please note system needs to reboot to get all the modification
activated.
Figure 5-48
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding function.
Figure 5-49
For the HDD group setup operation, please note:
Each channel’s records can be stored into the specified HDD Group.
Each HDD Group is corresponding to several hard disks, while one hard disk is only
included in one HDD Group.
Each channel is only corresponding with one HDD Group, while one HDD Group can
store records from several channels.
233
HDD Group is only available for read-write HDD and self-defined disks, other types of
hard disks cannot be set as HDD Group.
Important:
Current series software version can only set the HDD group operation of the read-write
HDDs. It is not for the redundancy HDD or read-only HDD.
HDD Setting
Click the button “HDD Settings” at the top right corner of the Figure 5-48, system will pop up an
interface as below. See Figure 5-50.
HDD: Here you can view the HDD amount the device can support. If there is a mark
in
the front of the number, it means current position has installed a HDD.
HDD Group: It lists the HDD Group number of current hard disk.
When you are setting the HDD Group, please check the box of the hard disk, and then choose
the corresponding HDD Group number and save the settings.
Please note, one HDD is corresponding to one group, while one group can have many HDDs.
The HDD group No. is corresponding HDD port, the HDD group No. may vary if you change the
HDD.
In Figure 5-50, you can see the system has two working hard disks at the first and second
position, and the first hard disk belongs to HDD Group 1, the second hard disk belongs to HDD
Group 2.
Important
Once you change the HDD Group settings, system will reboot!
Figure 5-50
Channels Setting
Click the button named with “Channels Settings” at the top right corner of the Figure 5-48,
system will pop up an interface shown as in Figure 5-51.
Channel: Here you can view the actual channel amount of the device.
Group No.:It is the SN in the HDD group management. Here we can set HDD 1 and HDD 2 sets
to as HDD group 1 and HDD group 2 respectively. You can see the HDD group option has only
two options 1 and 2 when you set corresponding HDD group of the channel.
When you set the channel setup, please select the corresponding channel such as 1 and 2, and
then select the HDD group such as 1. Click the Save button, you can complete the setup.
234
In the Figure 5-51, you set channel 1 and channel 3 to the corresponding HDD group2 and set
channel 2 and channel 4 to channel 16 to HDD group 1. In this setup, the records from channel 1
and channel 3 are both saved in HDD of the group 2. The records from channel 2 and channel 4
to channel 16 are all saved in HDD of the group 1.
When you are setting the configurations of the channels setting, please select relevant channels
first (such as channel 1 to 16), and then select the HDD Group NO. Please click the Save button
to save current setup.
Important
Once you change the HDD Group settings, system will pack the records and then reboot!
Tips
There is an easy way for you to test whether the records from the corresponding channel is
saved in the specified HDD. You can remove the HDD and then check the channel can record or
not. You can see the channel does not record and you can not search the previous record now.
Figure 5-51
Channel Quota
Please note only the product of the quota setup icon supports this function.
Here you can set channel storage capacity. See Figure 5-52.
235
Figure 5-52
Click Quota Setup button, you can go to Figure 5-53. Here you can set the each channel storage
capacity in each HDD.
Figure 5-53
Click Quota Statistics, you can go to the following interface. You can view HDD capacity you set
for each channel. See Figure 5-54.
236
Figure 5-54
5.5.2 Abnormality
Abnormality interface is shown as in Figure 5-55.
Event type: There are several options for you such as disk error, no disk, disconnection,
IP conflict, MAC conflict and etc.
Alarm output: Please select alarm activation output port (multiple choices).
Latch: Here you can set corresponding delaying time. The value ranges from 10s-300s.
System automatically delays specified seconds in turning off alarm and activated output after
external alarm cancelled.
Show message: system can pop up the message in the local screen to alert you when
alarm occurs.
Alarm upload: System can upload the alarm signal to the network (including alarm centre)
if you enabled current function.
Send email: System can send out email to alert you when alarm occurs.
Buzzer: Highlight the icon to enable this function. The buzzer beeps when alarm occurs.
Figure 5-55
5.5.3 Alarm Output
237
Here is for you to set proper alarm output.
Please highlight icon
to select the corresponding alarm output.
After all the setups please click OK button, system goes back to the previous menu. See Figure
5-56.
Figure 5-56
5.5.4 Manual Record
Please refer to chapter 4.3 manual record.
5.5.5 Account
Here is for you to implement account management. See Figure 5-57. Here you can:
Add new user
Modify user
Add group
Modify group
Modify password.
For account management please note:
For the user account name and the user group, the string max length is 6-byte. The
backspace in front of or at the back of the string is invalid. There can be backspace in the
middle. The string includes the valid character, letter, number, underline, subtraction sign,
and dot.
System account adopts two-level management: group and user. System max supports 20
user groups and 64 users.
For group or user management, there are two levels: admin and user.
One user should belong to one group. User right can not exceed group right.
About reusable function: this function allows multiple users use the same account to login.
About user account and MAC. When you add a new user, you can input the MAC address of
current user. Only the user of the same MAC address can access the device remotely.(MAC
address is for the device of the same LAN.) If you leave MAC address item in blank when
you add a new user, the user of any MAC address can access the device remotely. You can
set or change MAC address when you add or modify a user. The MAC address function is
also valid for PSS login. Please note current function does not support IPV6.
After all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
238
Figure 5-57
5.5.5.1 Modify Password
Click password button, the interface is shown as in Figure 5-58.
Here you can modify account password.
Please select the account from the dropdown list, input the old password and then input the new
password twice. Click the Save button to confirm current modification.
For the users of user account right, it can modify password of other users.
Figure 5-58
5.5.5.2 Add/Modify Group
Click add group button, the interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-59.
Here you can input group name and then input some memo information if necessary.
There are total 60 rights such as control panel, shut down, real-time monitor, playback, record,
record file backup, PTZ, user account, system information view, alarm input/output setup, system
setup, log view, clear log, upgrade system, control device and etc.
The modify group interface is similar to the Figure 5-59.
239
Figure 5-59
5.5.5.3 Add/Modify User
Click add user button, the interface is shown as in Figure 5-60.
Please input the user name, password, user MAC address and select the group it belongs to
from the dropdown list.
Then you can check the corresponding rights for current user.
For convenient user management, usually we recommend the general user right is lower than
the admin account.
The modify user interface is similar to Figure 5-60.
Figure 5-60
When you create a new user, you can input the corresponding MAC address of current user. If
you leave this item in blank, any MAC address user can share this user account to login. Please
note system needs to check the validity of MAC. Only the 12-digit 0-f format address can pass
the validity verification. System only saves small character even you input capitalized one. You
can see the corresponding prompt if there is any illegal input.
240
5.5.6 Auto Maintenance
Here you can set auto-reboot time and auto-delete old files setup. You can set to delete the files
for the specified days. See Figure 5-61.
You can select proper setup from dropdown list.
After all the setups please click save button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Figure 5-61
5.5.7 TV Adjust
Here is for you to adjust TV output setup. See Figure 5-62.
Please drag slide bar to adjust each item.
After all the setups please click OK button, system goes back to the previous menu.
Figure 5-62
5.5.8 Video Matrix
Here you can set matrix output channel and its interval. See Figure 5-63.
It can support the 1/4/9/16-window sport tour and you can specify the interval.
Note:
HD-SDI series product does not support this function,
960H series only supports single-window spot tour.
241
Figure 5-63
5.5.9 Card Overlay
The card overlay function is for financial areas. It includes Sniffer, information analysis and title
overlay function. The Sniffer mode includes COM and network.
5.5.9.1 COM Type
The COM interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-64.
Protocol: Please select from the dropdown list.
Setting: Click COM setting button, the interface is shown as in RS232 interface. Please refer
to Chapter 5.3.4 RS232.
Overlay channel: Please select the channel you want to overlay the card number.
Overlay mode: There are two options: preview and encode. Preview means overlay the card
number in the local monitor video. Encode means overlay the card number in the record file.
Overlay Position: Here you can select the proper overlay position from the dropdown list.
Figure 5-64
5.5.9.2 Network Type
The network type interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-65.
Here we take the ATM/POS protocol to continue.
There are two types: with or without the protocol according to client’s requirements.
242
With the protocol
For ATM/POS with the protocol, you just need to set the source IP, destination IP (sometimes
you need to input corresponding port number).
Figure 5-65
Without the protocol
For the ATM/POS without the protocol, the interface is shown as in Figure 5-66.
Source IP refers to host IP address that sends out information (usually it is the device host.)
Destination IP refers to other systems that receive information.
Usually you do not need to set source port and target port.
There are total four groups IP. The record channel applies to one group (optional) only.
Six frame ID groups verification can guarantee information validity and legal.
Figure 5-66
Click Data button you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 5-67.
Here you can set offset value, length, title according to your communication protocol and data
package. .
243
Figure 5-67
5.5.10 Config Backup
The configuration file backup interface is shown as below. See Figure 5-68.
This function allows you to import/export system configuration. You can use this function when
there are several devices need the same setup.
Export: Please connect the peripheral device first and then go to the following interface.
Click Export button, you can see there is a corresponding “Config_Time” folder. Double click
the folder, you can view some backup files.
Import: Here you can import the configuration files from the peripheral device to current
device. You need to select a folder first. You can see a dialogue box asking you to select a
folder if you are selecting a file. System pops up a dialogue box if there is no configuration
file under current folder. After successfully import, system needs to reboot to activate new
setup.
Format: Click Format button, system pops up a dialogue box for you to confirm current
operation. System begins format process after you click the OK button.
Note:
System can not open config backup interface again if there is backup operation in the
process.
System refreshes device when you go to the config backup every time and set current
directory as the root directory of the peripheral device.
If you go to the configuration backup interface first and then insert the peripheral device,
please click Refresh button to see the newly added device.
244
Figure 5-68
5.6 Information
Here is for you to view system information. There are total six items: HDD (hard disk information),
BPS (data stream statistics), log, version, online user and network information. See Figure 5-69.
Figure 5-69
5.6.1 HDD Information
Here is to list hard disk type, total space, free space, video start time and status. See See
Figure 5-70.○ means current HDD is normal. X means there is error. - means there is no HDD.
X391H391H391H
If disk is damaged, system shows as “?”. Please remove the broken hard disk before you add a
new one.
Once there is a hard disk confliction, please check hard disk time and system time is the same or
not. Please go to setting then general to modify system time. At last, reboot the system to solve
this problem.
245
After system booted up, if there is any confliction, system goes to HDD information interface
directly. Please note, system does not ask you to deal with it forcedly.
When HDD confliction occurs, you can check system time and HDD time are identical or not. If
they are not identical, please go to General (Chapter 5.3.1) to adjust system time or go to HDD
Management (Chapter 5.5.1) to format HDD and then reboot the DVR.
Figure 5-70
Tips:
Please click Fn button or left click mouse to view HDD record time and HDD type and time.
Double click one HDD information; you can see the HDD SMART information.
5.6.2 BPS
Here is for you to view current video data stream (KB/s) and occupied hard disk storage (MB/h).
See Figure 5-71.
Figure 5-71
5.6.3 Log
Here is for you to view system log file. System lists the following information. See Figure 5-72.
246
Log types include system operation, system configuration, data management, alarm event,
record operation, log clear, file operation and etc.
Start time/end time: Pleased select start time and end time, then click search button. You
can view the log files in a list. System max displays 100 logs in one page. It can max save
1024 log files. Please use page up/down button on the interface or the front panel to view
more.
Backup: Please select a folder you want to save; you can click the backup button to save the
log files. After the backup, you can see there is a folder named Log_time on the backup path.
Double click the folder, you can see the log file
Details: Click the Details button or double click the log item, you can view the detailed
information. See Figure 5-73. Here you can use rolling bar to view information, or you can
use Page up/Page down to view other log information. For the alarm event log such as video
loss, you can click the Playback button at the bottom right corner to playback.
Figure 5-72
247
Figure 5-73
5.6.4 Version
Here is for you to view hardware features, software version, built date, release SN information
and etc. You can also update system here. See Figure 5-74.
Start: Please insert the USB device that have the update file to the device and then click the
Start button to begin the update.
Important
Please make sure the upgrade file name shall be update.bin.
Figure 5-74
5.6.5 Online Users
Here is for you manage online users. See Figure 5-75.
You can disconnect one user or block one user if you have proper system right. Max
disconnection setup is 65535 seconds.
248
System refreshes current interface every five seconds to detect there is any newly added or
deleted user.
Figure 5-75
5.6.6 Network Information
In this interface, you can see network test and network load information.
5.6.6.1 Network Test
Network test interface is shown as in Figure 5-76.
Destination IP: Please input valid IPV4 address and domain name.
Test: Click it to test the connection with the destination IP address. The test results can
display average delay and packet loss rate and you can also view the network status as OK,
bad, no connection and etc.
Network Sniffer backup: Please insert USB2.0 device and click the Refresh button, you can
view the device on the following column. You can use the dropdown list to select peripheral
device. Click Browse button to select the snap path. The steps here are same as preview
backup operation.
You can view all connected network adapter names (including Ethernet, PPPoE, WIFI, and 3G),
you can click the button
on the right panel to begin Sniffer. Click the grey stop button to stop.
Please note system can not Sniffer several network adapters at the same time.
After Sniffer began, you can exit to implement corresponding network operation such as login
WEB, monitor. Please go back to Sniffer interface to click
stop Sniffer. System can save the
packets to the specified path. The file is named after “Network adapter name+time”. You can use
software such as Wireshark to open the packets on the PC for the professional engineer to solve
complicated problems.
249
Figure 5-76
5.6.6.2 Network Load
Network load is shown as in Figure 5-77. Here you can view the follow statistics of the device
network adapter.
Here you can view information of all connected network adapters. The connection status is
shown as offline if connection is disconnected. Click one network adapter, you can view the flow
statistics such as send rate and receive rate at the top panel
Figure 5-77
5.7 Shutdown
Double click shutdown button, system pops up a dialogue box for you to select. See Figure 5-78
Logout menu user: log out menu. You need to input password when you login the next time.
Restart application: reboot DVR.
250
Shutdown: system shuts down and turns off power.
Restart system: system begins rebooting.
Switch user: you can use another account to log in.
Figure 5-78
251
6 About Auxiliary Menu
6.1
Go to Pan/Tilt/Zoom
Pan/Tilt/Zoom Menu
In the one-window surveillance mode, right click mouse (click “fn” Button in the front panel or
click AUX key in the remote control). The interface is shown as below: See Figure 6-1 .
X397H397H397H
X
Figure 6-1
Click Pan/Tilt/Zoom, the interface is shown as in Figure 6-2 .
Here you can set the following items:
Zoom
Focus
Iris
Please click icon
and
to adjust zoom, focus and Iris.
X398H398H398H
X
Figure 6-2
In Figure 6-2 , please click direction arrows (See Figure 6-3 ) to adjust PTZ position. There
are totally eight direction arrows. (Please note there are only four direction arrows in DVR front
panel.)
X399H399H 399H
X
X400H400H400H
X
Figure 6-3
6.1.1 3D Intelligent Positioning Key
252
In the middle of the eight direction arrows, there is a 3D intelligent positioning key. See Figure
6-4 . Please make sure your protocol supports this function and you need to use mouse to
control.
Click this button, system goes back to the single screen mode. Drag the mouse in the screen to
adjust section size.
X401H401H401H
X
Figure 6-4
Here is a sheet for you reference.
Name
Function
function
key
Zoom
Near
Focus
Near
Iris
close
Shortcut
key
Function
key
│
⊳
function
Far
Far
Open
Shortcut
key
►│
6.2 Preset /Patrol / Pattern /Border
/Border Function
In Figure 6-2 click the set button. The interface is shown as below:
Here you can set the following items:
Preset
Patrol
Pattern
Border
X402H402H 402H
X
Figure 6-5
In Figure 6-2 , click page switch button, you can see an interface as in Figure 6-6 .
Here you can activate the following functions:
Preset
Tour(Patrol)
Pattern
Auto scan
Auto pan
Flip
Page Switch
X403H403H 403H
X
X404H404H404H
X
253
Figure 6-6
6.2.1 Preset Setup
Note: The following setups are usually operated in the Figure 6-2 , Figure 6-5 and Figure
6-6 .
In Figure 6-2 , use eight direction arrows to adjust camera to the proper position.
In Figure 6-5 , click preset button and input preset number. The interface is shown as in Figure
6-7 .
Add this preset to one patrol number
X405H405H405H
X
X406H406H406H
X
X407H407H407H
X
X408H408H 408H
X
X409H409H 409H
X
X410H410H410H
X
Figure 6-7
6.2.2 Activate Preset
In Figure 6-6 please input preset number in the No. blank, and click preset button.
X411H411H 411H
X
6.2.3 Patrol Setup
In Figure 6-5 , click patrol button. The interface is shown as in Figure 6-8 .
Input preset number and then add this preset to one patrol.
X412H412H 412H
X
X413H413H413H
X
Figure 6-8
6.2.4 Activate Patrol
In Figure 6-6 , input patrol number in the No. blank and click patrol button
X414H414H 414H
X
6.2.5 Pattern Setup
In Figure 6-5 , click pattern button and then click begin button. The interface shows like Figure
6-9 .
X415H415H 415H
X
X416H416H416H
X
254
Please go to Figure 6-2 to modify zoom, focus, and iris. Go back to Figure 6-9 and click end
button.
You can memorize all these setups as pattern 1.
X417H417H417H
X
X418H418H418H
X
Figure 6-9
6.2.6 Activate Pattern Function
In Figure 6-6 input mode value in the No. blank, and click pattern button.
X419H419H 419H
X
6.2.7 Border Setup
In Figure 6-5 , click border button. The interface is shown as in Figure 6-10 .
Please go to Figure 6-2 , use direction arrows to select camera left limit, and then please go to
Figure 6-10 and click left limit button
Repeat the above procedures to set right limit.
X420H420H 420H
X
X422H422H422H
X423H423H42 3H
X421H421H421H
X
X
X
Figure 6-10
6.2.8 Activate Border Function
In Figure 6-6 , click auto scan button, the system begins auto scan. Correspondingly, the auto
scan button changes to stop button.
Click stop button to terminate scan operation.
X424H424H 424H
X
1.1.1 Flip
In Figure 6-6 , click page switch button, you can see an interface is shown as below. See
Figure 6-11 . Here you can set auxiliary function.
Click page switch button again, system goes back to Figure 6-2 .
X425H425H 425H
X426H426H42 6H
X
X
X427H427H 427H
X
255
Figure 6-11
256
7 WEB OPERATION
There might be slightly difference in the interface due to different series.
The following interface is on our 8-channel series product.
7.1 Network Connection
onnection
Before web operation, please check the following items:
Network connection is right
DVR and PC network setup is right. Please refer to network setup(Setup ->Network)
Use order ping ***.***.***.***(* DVR IP address) to check connection is OK or not. Usually
the return TTL value should be less than 255.
Open the IE and then input DVR IP address.
System can automatically download latest web control and the new version can overwrite
the previous one.
If you want to un-install the web control, please run uninstall webrec3.0.bat. Or you can go to
C:\Program Files\webrec to remove single folder. Please note, before you un-install, please
close all web pages, otherwise the un-installation might result in error.
Current series product supports various browsers such as Safari, firebox browser, Google
browser. Device only support 1-channel monitor on the Apple PC.
7.2 Login
Open IE and input DVR address in the address column. For example, if your DVR IP is
10.10.3.16, then please input http:// 10.10.3.16 in IE address column. See Figure 7-1.
Input your IP
address here.
Figure 7-1
System pops up warning information to ask you whether install webrec.cab control or not. Please
click yes button.
If you can’t download the ActiveX file, please modify your settings as follows. See Figure 7-2.
257
Figure 7-2
After installation, the interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-3.
Please input your user name and password.
Default factory name is admin and password is admin.
Then you can select the login mode: LAN and WAN.
Note: For security reasons, please modify your password after you first login.
Figure 7-3
258
7.3 LAN Mode
For the LAN mode, after you logged in, you can see the main window. See Figure 7-9.
This main window can be divided into the following sections.
Section 1: there are five function buttons: Live(chapter 7.4), setup (chapter 7.8), search
(chapter 7.9), alarm (chapter 7.10), and logout (chapter 7.11).
Section 2: There are channel number and one button: Start all. Start all button is to
enable/disable all-channel real-time monitor. Click it the button becomes yellow. See Figure
7-4.
Figure 7-4
Please refer to Figure 7-5 for main stream and extra stream switch information.
Figure 7-5
Section 3: Start dialogue button.
You can click this button to enable audio talk. Click 【▼】 to select bidirectional talk mode.
There are four options: DEFAULT,G711a,G711u and PCM. After you enable the bidirectional
talk, the Start talk button becomes End Talk button and it becomes yellow. See Figure 7-6.
Please note, the audio input port from the device to the client-end is using the first channel audio
input port. During the bidirectional talk process, system will not encode the audio data from the 1channel.
Figure 7-6
259
Section 4: Instant record button. Click it, the button becomes yellow and system begins
manual record. See Figure 7-7. Click it again, system restores previous record mode..
Figure 7-7
Section 5: Local play button.
The Web can playback the saved (Extension name is dav) files in the PC-end.
Click local play button, system pops up the following interface for you to select local play file. See
Figure 7-8.
Figure 7-8
Section 6: From the left to the right ,you can see video quality/fluency/ full screen/1window/4-window/6-window/8-window/9-window/13-window/16-window/20-window/25window/36-window.. You can set video fluency and real-time feature priority.
Section 7: PTZ operation panel. Please refer to chapter 7.5 for detailed information.
Section 8: Image setup and alarm setup. Please refer to chapter 7.6 for detailed information.
Figure 7-9
260
7.4 RealReal-time Monitor
In section 2, left click the channel name you want to view, you can see the corresponding video
in current window.
On the top left corner, you can view device IP, channel number, network monitor bit stream. See
Figure 7-10.
1
2
3
Figure 7-10
On the top right corer, there are six unction buttons. See Figure 7-11.
1 2
3 4
5
6
Figure 7-11
1: Digital zoom: Click this button and then left drag the mouse in the zone to zoom in. right
click mouse system restores original status.
2: Local record. When you click local record button, the system begins recording and this
button becomes highlighted. You can go to system folder RecordDownload to view the
recorded file.
3: Snapshot picture. You can snapshoot important video. All images are memorized in
system client folder PictureDownload (default).
4: Audio :Turn on or off audio.(It has no relationship with system audio setup )
5: Close video.
7.5 PTZ
Before PTZ operation, please make sure you have properly set PTZ protocol. (Please refer to
chapter 7.8.5.9).
There are eight direction keys. In the middle of the eight direction keys, there is a 3D intelligent
positioning key.
Click 3D intelligent positioning key, system goes back to the single screen mode. Drag the
mouse in the screen to adjust section size. It can realize PTZ automatically.
Please refer to the following sheet for PTZ setup information.
Parameter
Function
Scan
Select Scan from the dropdown list.
Click Set button, you can set scan left and right limit.
Use direction buttons to move the camera to you desired
location and then click left limit button. Then move the camera
again and then click right limit button to set a right limit.
261
Parameter
Function
Preset
Tour
Pattern
Aux
Light and
wiper
Select Preset from the dropdown list.
Turn the camera to the corresponding position and Input the
preset value. Click Add button to add a preset,.
Select Tour from the dropdown list.
Input preset value in the column. Click Add preset button, you
have added one preset in the tour.
Repeat the above procedures you can add more presets in one
tour.
Or you can click delete preset button to remove one preset from
the tour.
Select Pattern from the dropdown list.
You can input pattern value and then click Start button to begin
PTZ movement such as zoom, focus, iris, direction and etc.
Then you can click Add button to set one pattern.
Please input the corresponding aux value here.
You can select one option and then click AUX on or AUX off
button.
You can turn on or turn off the light/wiper.
3D Intelligent Positioning
Key
You can click this icon to
display or hide the PTZ
control platform.
Figure 7-12
7.6 Image/RelayImage/Relay-out
Select one monitor channel video and then click Image button in section 8, the interface is shown
as Figure 7-13.
7.6.1 Image
Here you can adjust its brightness, contrast, hue and saturation. (Current channel border
becomes green).
Or you can click Reset button to restore system default setup.
262
Figure 7-13
7.6.2 Relay output
Here you can select alarm output channel, the select channel alarm mode becomes manual and
alarm is enabled. See Figure 7-14.
Figure 7-14
7.6.3 Multiple-channel preview
System allows you to preview several channels on one channel. It supports 1/4/8/9-window. See
Figure 7-15.
Please note only the product of this icon can support current function.
Figure 7-15
7.7 WAN Login
In WAN mode, after you logged in, the interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-16.
263
Figure 7-16
Please refer to the following contents for LAN and WAN login difference.
1) In the WAN mode, system opens the main stream of the first channel to monitor by default.
The open/close button on the left pane is null.
2) You can select different channel and different monitor mode at the bottom of the interface. See
Figure 7-17.
264
Figure 7-17
Important
The window display mode and the channel number are by default. For example, for the 16channel, the max window split mode is 16.
3) Multiple-channel monitor, system adopts extra stream to monitor by default. Double click one
channel, system switches to single channel and system uses main stream to monitor. You can
view there are two icons at the left top corner of the channel number for you reference. M stands
for main stream. S stands for sub stream (extra stream).
4) If you login via the WAN mode, system does not support alarm activation to open the video
function in the Alarm setup interface.
Important
For multiple-channel monitor mode, system adopts extra stream to monitor by default. You
can not modify manually. All channels are trying to synchronize. Please note the
synchronization effect still depends on your network environments.
For bandwidth consideration, system can not support monitor and playback at the same time.
System auto closes monitor or playback interface when you are searching setup in the
configuration interface. It is to enhance search speed.
7.8 Setup
7.8.1 Channel
7.8.1.1 Conditions
Here you can view device property information. The setups become valid immediately after you
set. See Figure 7-18.
265
Figure 7-18
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Channel
Please select a channel from the dropdown list.
Period
It divides one day (24 hours) to two periods. You can set
different hue, brightness, and contrast for different periods.
Hue
It is to adjust monitor video brightness and darkness level. The
default value is 50.
The bigger the value is, the large the contrast between the
bright and dark section is and vice versa.
Brightness
It is to adjust monitor window brightness. The default value is
50.
The larger the number is , the bright the video is. When you
input the value here, the bright section and the dark section of
the video will be adjusted accordingly. You can use this
function when the whole video is too dark or too bright. Please
note the video may become hazy if the value is too high. The
value ranges from 0 to 100.The recommended value ranges
from 40 to 60.
Contrast
It is to adjust monitor window contrast. The value ranges from 0
to 100. The default value is 50.
The larger the number is, the higher the contrast is. You can
use this function when the whole video bright is OK but the
contrast is not proper. Please note the video may become hazy
if the value is too low. If this value is too high, the dark section
may lack brightness while the bright section may over
exposure .The recommended value ranges from 40 to 60.
Saturation
It is to adjust monitor window saturation. The value ranges from
0 to 100. The default value is 50.
The larger the number is, the strong the color is. This value has
no effect on the general brightness of the whole video. The
video color may become too strong if the value is too high. For
the grey part of the video, the distortion may occur if the white
266
balance is not accurate. Please note the video may not be
attractive if the value is too low. The recommended value
ranges from 40 to 60.
Gain
The gain adjust is to set the gain value. The smaller the value
is, the low the noise is. But the brightness is also too low in the
dark environments. It can enhance the video brightness if the
value is high. But the video noise may become too clear.
White level
It is to enhance video effect.
Color mode
It includes several modes such as standard, color. You can
select corresponding color mode here, you can see hue,
brightness, and contrast and etc will adjust accordingly.
7.8.1.2 Video and Audio
7.8.1.2.1
Encode
The encode interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-19.
Figure 7-19
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Channel
Please select a channel from the dropdown list.
Video enable
Check the box here to enable extra stream video. This item is
enabled by default.
Code stream
type
It includes main stream, motion stream and alarm stream. You
can select different encode frame rates form different recorded
events.
System supports active control frame function (ACF). It allows
you to record in different frame rates.
For example, you can use high frame rate to record important
events, record scheduled event in lower frame rate and it allows
you to set different frame rates for motion detection record and
alarm record.
267
Compression
The main bit stream supports H.264. The extra stream supports
H.264, MJPG.
Resolution
System supports various resolutions, you can select from the
dropdown list. The main stream supports
D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF and the extra stream supports
CIF/QCIF. Please note the option may vary due to different
series.
Note:
a). For HD-SDI series, the main code-stream types are
1080P/720P/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF; Extra stream resolution
supports D1/CIF/QCIF.
b). For 960H series, the main code-stream types are
960H/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF; Extra stream resolution
supports 960H/D1/HD1/2CIF/CIF/QCIF.
Frame Rate
PAL:1~25f/s;NTSC:1~30f/s.
Note:
:
For the 16-channel series product of the HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U
series product and the HD-SDI 1080P 2U series product,
when the main stream resolution is 1080P/720P, the frame
rate of the 1/5/9/13-channel max supports 25f/s or 30f/s and
the frame rate of the rest channels support 12f/s or 15f/s. The
extras stream of the HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U series product and
the HD-SDI 1080P 2U series product support D1 (6fps or
7f/s.)
Bit Rate
Main stream: You can set bit rate here to change video
quality. The large the bit rate is , the better the quality is.
Please refer to recommend bit rate for the detailed
information.
Extra stream: In CBR, the bit rate here is the max value.
In dynamic video, system needs to low frame rate or
video quality to guarantee the value. The value is null in
VBR mode.
Reference bit
rate
Recommended bit rate value according to the resolution and
frame rate you have set.
I Frame
Here you can set the P frame amount between two I frames.
The value ranges from 1 to 150. Default value is 50.
Recommended value is frame rate *2.
Watermark
enable
7.8.1.2.2
This function allows you to verify the video is tampered or not.
Here you can select watermark bit stream, watermark mode
and watermark character. Default character is DigitalCCTV. The
max length is 85-digit. The character can only include number,
character and underline.
Snapshot
The snapshot interface is shown as in Figure 7-20.
268
Figure 7-20
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Snapshot type
There are two modes: Timing (schedule) and Event
(activation).
Timing snapshot is valid during the specified period you
set.
Activation snapshot only is valid when motion detect alarm,
camera masking alarm or local activation alarm occurs.
Image size
It is the same with the resolution of the main stream.
Quality
It is to set the image quality. There are six levels.
Interval
It is to set snapshot frequency. The value ranges from 1s to 7s.
Copy
Click it; you can copy current channel setup to other
channel(s).
7.8.1.2.3
Video Overlay
The video overlay interface is shown as in Figure 7-21.
Figure 7-21
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
269
Parameter
Function
Cover-area
Check Preview or Monitor first.
(Privacy mask)
Click Set button, you can privacy mask the specified video in
the preview or monitor video.
System max supports 4 privacy mask zones.
Time Title
You can enable this function so that system overlays time
information in video window.
You can use the mouse to drag the time title position.
You can view time title on the live video of the WEB or the
playback video.
Channel Title
You can enable this function so that system overlays channel
information in video window.
You can use the mouse to drag the channel title position.
You can view channel title on the live video of the WEB or the
playback video.
7.8.1.2.4
Path
The storage path interface is shown as in Figure 7-22.
Here you can set snap image saved path (
path (
in the preview interface) and the record storage
in the preview interface).The default setup is C:\PictureDownload and
C:\RecordDownload.
Please click the Save button to save current setup.
Figure 7-22
7.8.1.3 Channel Name
Here you can set channel name. See Figure 7-23.
Figure 7-23
270
7.8.2 Network
7.8.2.1 TCP/IP
The TCP/IP interface is shown as in Figure 7-24.
Figure 7-24
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Mode
There are two modes: static mode and the DHCP mode.
The IP/submask/gateway are null when you select the
DHCP mode to auto search the IP.
If you select the static mode, you need to set the
IP/submask/gateway manually.
If you select the DHCP mode, you can view the
IP/submask/gateway from the DHCP.
If you switch from the DHCP mode to the static mode, you
need to reset the IP parameters.
Besides, IP/submask/gateway and DHCP are read-only
when the PPPoE dial is OK.
Mac Address
It is to display host Mac address.
IP Version
It is to select IP version. IPV4 or IPV6.
You can access the IP address of these two versions.
IP Address
Please use the keyboard to input the corresponding number to
modify the IP address and then set the corresponding subnet
mask and the default gateway.
Preferred DNS
DNS IP address.
Alternate DNS
Alternate DNS IP address.
For the IP address of IPv6 version, default gateway, preferred DNS and
alternate DNS, the input value shall be 128-digit. It shall not be left in blank.
LAN load
System can process the downloaded data first if you enable
this function. The download speed is 1.5X or 2.0X of the normal
speed.
271
7.8.2.2 Connection
The connection interface is shown as in Figure 7-25.
Figure 7-25
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Max connection
It is the max Web connection for the same device. The value
ranges from 1 to 20. The default setup is 10.
TCP port
The default value is 37777. You can input the actual port
number if necessary.
UDP port
The default value is 37778. You can input the actual port
number if necessary.
HTTP port
The default value is 80. You can input the actual port number if
necessary.
HTTPS port
The default value is 443. You can input the actual port number
if necessary.
RTSP port
The default value is 554.
7.8.2.3 WIFI
Please note this function is for the device of WIFI module.
The WIFI interface is shown as in Figure 7-26.
272
Figure 7-26
Please check the box to enable WIFI function and then click the Search SSID button. Now you
can view all the wireless network information in the following list. Double click a name to connect
to it. Click Refresh button, you can view latest connection status.
7.8.2.4 3G
7.8.2.4.1
CDMA/GPRS
The CDMA/GPRS interface is shown as in Figure 7-27.
Figure 7-27
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
WLAN type
Here you can select 3G network type to distinguish the 3G
module from different ISP. The types include WCDMA,
CDMA1x and etc.
273
APN/Dial No.
Here is the important parameter of PPP.
Authorization
It includes PAP,CHAP,NO_AUTH.
Pulse interval
It is to set time to end 3G connection after you close extra
stream monitor. For example, if you input 60 here, system ends
3G connection after you close extra stream monitor 60
seconds.
Important
If the pulse interval is 0, then system does not end 3G connection after
you close the extra stream monitor.
Pulse interval here is for extra stream only. This item is null if you are
using main stream to monitor.
7.8.2.4.2
Mobile
The mobile setup interface is shown as in Figure 7-28.
Here you can activate or turn off the 3G connected phone or mobile phone, or the phone you set
to get alarm message.
Figure 7-28
7.8.2.5 PPPoE
The PPPoE interface is shown as in Figure 7-29.
Input the PPPoE user name and password you get from the IPS (internet service provider) and
enable PPPoE function. Please save current setup and then reboot the device to get the setup
activated.
Device connects to the internet via PPPoE after reboot. You can get the IP address in the WAN
from the IP address column.
Please note, you need to use previous IP address in the LAN to login the device. Please
go to the IP address item to via the device current device information. You can access the
client-end via this new address.
274
Figure 7-29
7.8.2.6 DDNS
The DDNS interface is shown as in Figure 7-30.
The DDNS is to set to connect the various servers so that you can access the system via the
server. Please go to the corresponding service website to apply a domain name and then access
the system via the domain. It works even your IP address has changed.
Please select DDNS from the dropdown list (Multiple choices). Before you use this function,
please make sure your purchased device support current function.
Figure 7-30
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Server Type
You can select DDNS protocol from the dropdown list and then
enable DDNS function.
275
Parameter
Function
Server IP
DDNS server IP address
Server Port
DDNS server port.
Domain Name
Your self-defined domain name.
User
The user name you input to log in the server.
Password
The password you input to log in the server.
Update period
Device sends out alive signal to the server regularly.
You can set interval value between the device and DDNS server
here.
Quick DDNS and Client-end Introduction
1) Background Introduction
Device IP is not fixed if you use ADSL to login the network. The DDNS function allows you to
access the DVR via the registered domain name. Besides the general DDNS, the quick DDNS
works with the device from the manufacturer so that it can add the extension function.
2) Function Introduction
The quick DDNS client has the same function as other DDNS client end. It realizes the bonding
of the domain name and the IP address. Right now, current DDNS server is for our own devices
only. You need to refresh the bonding relationship of the domain and the IP regularly. There is no
user name, password or the ID registration on the server. At the same time, each device has a
default domain name (Generated by MAC address) for your option. You can also use customized
valid domain name (has not registered.).
3) Operation
Before you use Quick DDNS, you need to enable this service and set proper server address, port
value and domain name.
Server address:www.quickddns.com
Port number:80
Domain name:There are two modes: Default domain name and customized domain name.
Except default domain name registration, you can also use customized domain name (You can
input your self-defined domain name.) After successful registration, you can use domain name
to login installed of the device IP.
User name: It is optional. You can input your commonly used email address.
Important
Do not register frequently. The interval between two registrations shall be more than 60
seconds. Too many registration requests may result in server attack.
System may take back the domain name that is idle for one year. You can get a notification
email before the cancel operation if your email address setup is OK.
7.8.2.7 IP filter
The IP filter interface is shown as in Figure 7-31.
After you enabled trusted sites function, only the IP listed below can access current DVR.
If you enable blocked sites function, the following listed IP addresses can not access current
DVR.
276
Figure 7-31
7.8.2.8 Email
The email interface is shown as in Figure 7-32.
Figure 7-32
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Enable
Please check the box here to enable email function.
SMTP Server
Input server address and then enable this function.
Port
Default value is 25. You can modify it if necessary.
Anonymity
For the server supports the anonymity function. You can auto
login anonymously. You do not need to input the user name.
277
Parameter
Function
password and the sender information.
User Name
The user name of the sender email account.
Password
The password of sender email account.
Sender
Sender email address.
Authentication
(Encryption
mode)
You can select SSL or none.
Subject
Input email subject here.
Attachment
System can send out the email of the snapshot picture once
you check the box here.
Receiver
Input receiver email address here. Max three addresses.
It supports SSL,TLS email box.
The send interval ranges from 0 to 3600 seconds. 0 means
there is no interval.
Please note system will not send out the email immediately
when the alarm occurs. When the alarm, motion detection or
the abnormity event activates the email, system sends out the
email according to the interval you specified here. This
function is very useful when there are too many emails
activated by the abnormity events, which may result in heavy
load for the email server.
Please check the box here to enable this function.
Interval
Health mail
enable
Update period
(interval)
Email test
This function allows the system to send out the test email to
check the connection is OK or not.
Please check the box to enable this function and then set the
corresponding interval.
System can send out the email regularly as you set here.
The system will automatically sent out a email once to test the
connection is OK or not .Before the email test, please save
the email setup information.
7.8.2.9 UPnP
It allows you to establish the mapping relationship between the LAN and the public network.
Here you can also add, modify or remove UPnP item. See Figure 7-33.
In the Windows OS, From Start->Control Panel->Add or remove programs. Click the
“Add/Remove Windows Components” and then select the “Network Services” from the
Windows Components Wizard.
Click the Details button and then check the “Internet Gateway Device Discovery and Control
client” and “UPnP User Interface”. Please click OK to begin installation.
Enable UPnP from the Web. If your UPnP is enabled in the Windows OS, the DVR can auto
detect it via the “My Network Places”
278
Figure 7-33
7.8.2.10 SNMP
The SNMP interface is shown as in Figure 7-34.
The SNMP allows the communication between the network management work station software
and the proxy of the managed device.
Figure 7-34
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
SNMP Port
The listening port of the proxy program of the device. It is a
UDP port not a TCP port. The value ranges from 1 to 65535.
The default value is 161
Read Community
It is a string. It is a command between the manage process
and the proxy process. It defined the authentication, access
279
Parameter
Write Community
Trap address
Trap port
SNMP version
Function
control and the management relationship between one proxy
and one group of the managers. Please make sure the device
and the proxy are the same.
The read community will read all the objects the SNMP
supported in the specified name. The default setup is public.
It is a string. It is a command between the manage process
and the proxy process. It defined the authentication, access
control and the management relationship between one proxy
and one group of the managers. Please make sure the device
and the proxy are the same.
The read community will read/write/access all the objects the
SNMP supported in the specified name. The default setup is
write.
The destination address of the Trap information from the
proxy program of the device.
The destination port of the Trap information from the proxy
program of the device. It is for the gateway device and the
client-end PC in the LAN to exchange the information. It is a
non-protocol connection port. It has no effect on the network
applications. It is a UDP port not TCP port. The value ranges
from 1 to 165535. The default value is 162.
Check V1, system only processes the information of V1.
Check V2, system only processes the information of V2.
Check SNMP V3.you can set user name and password.
There is account security verification when the server
wants to connect to the device. At the same time, the v1
and V2 is null and can not select.
7.8.2.11 Multicast
The multicast interface is shown as in Figure 7-35.
Multicast is a transmission mode of data packet. When there is multiple-host to receive the same
data packet, multiple-cast is the best option to reduce the broad width and the CPU load. The
source host can just send out one data to transit. This function also depends on the relationship
of the group member and group of the outer.
280
Figure 7-35
7.8.2.12 Auto Regitser
The auto register interface is shown as in Figure 7-36. After the device connects to the network,
it can send out auto register query to the specified server.
Figure 7-36
7.8.2.13 Alarm Centre
The alarm centre interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-37.
This interface is reserved for you to develop. System can upload alarm signal to the alarm centre
when local alarm occurs.
Before you use alarm centre, please set server IP, port and etc. When an alarm occurs, system
can send out data as the protocol defined, so the client-end can get the data.
Figure 7-37
281
7.8.2.14 HTTPS
In this interface, you can set to make sure the PC can successfully login via the HTTPS. It is to
guarantee communication data security. The reliable and stable technology can secure the user
information security and device safety. See Figure 7-38.
Note
You need to implement server certificate again if you have changed device IP.
You need to download root certificate if it is your first time to use HTTPS on current
PC.
Figure 7-38
7.8.2.14.1 Create server cerficate
If it is your first time to use this function, please follow the steps listed below.
In Figure 7-38, click
button, input country name, state name and etc.
Click Create button. See Figure 7-39.
Note
Please make sure the IP or domain information is the same as your device IP or domain name.
Figure 7-39
282
You can see the corresponding prompt. See Figure 7-40. Now the server certificate is
successfully created.
Figure 7-40
7.8.2.14.2 Donwload root certificate
In Figure 7-38, click
button, system pops up a dialogue box. See Figure
7-41.
Figure 7-41
Click Open button, you can go to the following interface. See Figure 7-42.
283
Figure 7-42
Click Install Certificate button, you can go to certificate wizard. See Figure 7-43.
Figure 7-43
Click Next button to continue. Now you can select a location for the certificate. See Figure 7-44.
284
Figure 7-44
Click Next button, you can see the certificate import process is complete. See Figure 7-45.
Figure 7-45
Click Finish button, you can see system pops up a security warning dialogue box. See Figure
7-46.
285
Figure 7-46
Click Yes button, system pops up the following dialogue box, you can see the certificate
download is complete. See Figure 7-47.
Figure 7-47
7.8.2.14.3 View and set HTTPS port
From Setup->Network->Connection, you can see the following interface. See Figure 7-48.
You can see HTTPS default value is 443.
Figure 7-48
7.8.2.14.4 HTTPS Login
Open the browser and then input https://xx.xx.xx.xx:port.
xx.xx.xx.xx: is your device IP or domain mane.
Port is your HTTPS port. If you are using default HTTPS value 443, you do not need to add port
information here. You can input https://xx.xx.xx.xx to access.
Now you can see the login interface if your setup is right.
7.8.3 Event
7.8.3.1 Video detect
7.8.3.1.1
Motion Detect
The motion detect interface is shown as in Figure 7-49.
286
Figure 7-49
Figure 7-50
Figure 7-51
287
Figure 7-52
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Enable
You need to check the box to enable motion detection function.
Please select a channel from the dropdown list.
Period
Motion detection function becomes activated in the specified
periods. See Figure 7-50.
There are six periods in one day. Please draw a circle to enable
corresponding period.
Click OK button, system goes back to motion detection interface,
please click save button to exit.
Anti-dither
System only memorizes one event during the anti-dither period.
The value ranges from 5s to 600s.
Sensitivity
There are six levels. The sixth level has the highest sensitivity.
Region
There are six levels. The sixth level has the highest sensitivity.
Region: If you select motion detection type, you can click this
button to set motion detection zone. The interface is shown as in
Figure 7-51. There are PAL 22X18/NTSC 22X15 zones. Right
click mouse you can go to full-screen display mode. Do remember
clicking OK button to save your motion detection zone setup.
Record
channel
System auto activates motion detection channel(s) to record once
an alarm occurs. Please note you need to set motion detect
record period and go to Storage-> Schedule to set current
channel as schedule record.
Record Delay
System can delay the record for specified time after alarm ended.
The value ranges from 10s to 300s.
Alarm out
Enable alarm activation function. You need to select alarm output
port so that system can activate corresponding alarm device when
an alarm occurs.
Latch
System can delay the alarm output for specified time after an
alarm ended. The value ranges from 1s to 300s.
Show
message
System can pop up a message to alarm you in the local host
screen if you enabled this function.
288
Parameter
Function
Buzzer
Check the box here to enable this function. The buzzer beeps
when an alarm occurs.
Alarm upload
System can upload the alarm signal to the centre (Including alarm
centre.
Message
When 3G network connection is OK, system can send out a
message when motion detect occurs.
Send Email
If you enabled this function, System can send out an email to alert
you when an alarm occurs.
Tour
You need to check the box here to enable this function. System
begins 1-wiindow or multiple-window tour display among the
channel(s) you set to record when an alarm occurs.
Please go to chapter 5.3.9 to set tour interval and tour mode.
PTZ
Activation
Here you can set PTZ movement when alarm occurs. Such as go
to preset X. See Figure 7-52.
Video Matrix
This function is for motion detect only. Check the box here to
enable video matrix function. Right now system supports onechannel tour function. System takes “first come and first serve”
principle to deal with the activated tour. System will process the
new tour when a new alarm occurs after previous alarm ended.
Otherwise it restores the previous output status before the alarm
activation.
7.8.3.1.2
Video Loss
The video loss interface is shown as in Figure 7-53.
After analysis video, system can generate a video loss alarm when the detected moving signal
reached the sensitivity you set here.
Please note video loss does not support anti-dither, sensitivity, region setup. For rest setups,
please refer to chapter 7.8.3.1.1 motion detect for detailed information.
Figure 7-53
7.8.3.1.3
Camera Masking
The camera masking interface is shown as in Figure 7-54.
289
After analysis video, system can generate a camera masking alarm when the detected moving
signal reached the sensitivity you set here.
For detailed setups, please refer to chapter 7.8.3.1.1 motion detect for detailed information.
Figure 7-54
7.8.3.2 Alarm
Before operation, please make sure you have properly connected alarm devices such as
buzzer. The input mode includes local alarm and network alarm.
7.8.3.2.1
Local Alarm
The local alarm interface is shown as in Figure 7-55.
Figure 7-55
290
Figure 7-56
Figure 7-57
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Enable
You need to check the box to enable this function.
Please select a channel from the dropdown list.
Period
This function becomes activated in the specified periods.
There are six periods in one day. Please draw a circle to
enable corresponding period.
Select date. If you do not select, current setup applies to
today only. You can select all week column to apply to the
whole week.
Click OK button, system goes back to local alarm
interface, please click save button to exit.
Anti-dither
Sensor type
Record channel
System only memorizes one event during the anti-dither
period. The value ranges from 5s to 600s.
There are two options: NO/NC.
System auto activates motion detection channel(s) to
record once an alarm occurs. Please note you need to set
alarm record period and go to Storage-> Schedule to set
291
Parameter
Function
current channel as schedule record.
Record Delay
System can delay the record for specified time after alarm
ended. The value ranges from 10s to 300s.
Alarm out
Enable alarm activation function. You need to select alarm
output port so that system can activate corresponding
alarm device when an alarm occurs.
Latch
System can delay the alarm output for specified time after
an alarm ended. The value ranges from 1s to 300s.
Show message
System can pop up a message to alarm you in the local
host screen if you enabled this function.
Buzzer
Check the box here to enable this function. The buzzer
beeps when an alarm occurs.
Alarm upload
System can upload the alarm signal to the centre
(Including alarm centre.
Send Email
If you enabled this function, System can send out an
email to alert you when an alarm occurs.
Tour
You need to check the box here to enable this function.
System begins 1-wiindow or multiple-window tour display
among the channel(s) you set to record when an alarm
occurs.
Please go to chapter 5.3.9 to set tour interval and tour
mode.
PTZ Activation
7.8.3.2.2
Here you can set PTZ movement when alarm occurs.
Such as go to preset X.
Net Alarm
The network alarm interface is shown as in Figure 7-58.
Network alarm refers to the alarm signal from the network. System does not anti-dither and
sensor type setup. For reset setups, please refer to chapter 7.8.3.2.1.
Figure 7-58
7.8.3.2.3
Alarm Out
292
Here you can set alarm output channel mode. See Figure 7-59.
Figure 7-59
7.8.3.3 Abnormity
It includes six statuses: No disk, disk error, net disconnection, IP conflict and MAC conflict. See
Figure 7-60 through Figure 7-65.
Figure 7-60
Figure 7-61
293
Figure 7-62
Figure 7-63
Figure 7-64
Figure 7-65
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Event
Type
The abnormal events include: No disk, disk error, disk no space, net
disconnection, IP conflict and MAC conflict.
You can set one or more items here.
Less than: You can set the minimum percentage value here (For disk
not space only). The device can alarm when capacity is not sufficient.
You need to draw a circle to enable this function.
Enable
Check the box here to enable selected function.
Alarm Out
Please select corresponding alarm output channel when an alarm
occurs. You need to check the box to enable this function.
Latch
The alarm output can delay for the specified time after an alarm stops.
294
Parameter
Function
The value ranges from 1s to 300s.
Show
message
System can pop up a message to alarm you in the local host screen if
you enabled this function.
Alarm
upload
System can upload the alarm signal to the centre (Including alarm
centre.
Send
Email
If you enabled this function, System can send out an email to alert you
when an alarm occurs.
Buzzer
Check the box here to enable this function. The buzzer beeps when an
alarm occurs.
7.8.4 Storage
7.8.4.1 Schedule
In this interfaces, you can add or remove the schedule record setup. See Figure 7-66.
There are three record modes: general (auto), motion detect and alarm. There are six periods in
one day. Please make sure you have enabled the corresponding record mode in the Setup>Storage->Conditions.
You can view the current time period setup from the color bar.
Green color stands for the general record/snapshot.
Yellow color stands for the motion detect record/snapshot..
Red color stands for the alarm record/snapshot.
Figure 7-66
295
Figure 7-67
Figure 7-68
Figure 7-69
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Channel
Please select a channel from the dropdown list.
296
Parameter
Function
Pre-record
Please input pre-record time here. The value ranges from 0 to 30.
Redundancy
Check the box here to enable redundancy function. Please note this
function is null if there is only one HDD.
Snapshot
Check the box here to enable snapshot function.
Holiday
Check the box here to enable holiday function.
Setup
(Sunday to
Saturday)
Click the Setup button, you can set record period. See Figure 7-67.
There are six periods in one day. If you do not check the date at the
bottom of the interface, current setup is for today only.
Please click Save button and then exit.
Setup
(Holiday)
Click the Setup button, you can set record period. See Figure 7-68.
There are six periods in one day. If you check Holiday box, current
channel shall record as your holiday setup here.
Copy
Copy function allows you to copy one channel setup to another. After
setting in channel, click Copy button, you can go to interface Figure
7-69. You can see current channel name is grey such as channel 1.
Now you can select the channel you wan to paste such as channel
5/6/7. If you wan to save current setup of channel 1 to all channels,
you can click the first box “ALL”. Click the OK button to save current
copy setup. Click the OK button in the Encode interface, the copy
function succeeded.
7.8.4.2 Storage
7.8.4.2.1
Local Storage
The local interface is shown as in Figure 7-70. Here you can see storage device information. You
can also operate the read-only, write-only, hot swap and format operation.
Figure 7-70
7.8.4.2.2
HDD Setting
Here is for you to set HDD group. See Figure 7-71.
297
Figure 7-71
7.8.4.2.3
HDD Channel
The HDD channel interface is shown as in Figure 7-72. Here you can set channel group.
Figure 7-72
7.8.4.2.4
FTP
The FTP interface is shown as in Figure 7-73.
The FTP function is on if you check the Enable box here.
When network is offline or malfunction, system can save record or picture to HDD.
Figure 7-73
7.8.4.3 Record control
The record control interface is shown as in Figure 7-74.
298
Figure 7-74
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Channel
Here you can view channel number.
The number displayed here is the max channel amount of your
device.
Status
There are three statuses: schedule, manual and stop.
Schedule
System enables auto record function as you set in record schedule
setup (general, motion detect and alarm).
Manual
It has the highest priority.
Enable corresponding channel to record no matter what period
applied in the record setup.
Stop current channel record no matter what period applied in the
record setup.
Check the corresponding All button, you can enable or disable all
channels record.
Stop
Start all/
stop all
7.8.5 System
7.8.5.1 General
The general interface includes General, date/time and holiday setup.
7.8.5.1.1
General
The general interface is shown as in Figure 7-75.
299
Figure 7-75
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Device ID
It is to set device name.
Device No.
It is device channel number.
Language
You can select the language from the dropdown list.
Please note the device needs to reboot to get the modification
activated.
Video
Standard
This is to display video standard such as PAL.
HDD full
Here is for you to select working mode when hard disk is full. There
are two options: stop recording or rewrite. If current working HDD is
overwritten or the current HDD is full while the next HDD is no
empty, then system stops recording, If the current HDD is full and
then next HDD is not empty, then system overwrites the previous
files.
Here is for you to specify record duration. The value ranges from 1
to 120 minutes. Default value is 60 minutes.
Pack
duration
7.8.5.1.2
Date and time
The date and time interface is shown as in Figure 7-76
Figure 7-76
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Date format
Here you can select date format from the dropdown list.
Time
Format
There are two options: 24-H and 12-H.
Time zone
The time zone of the device.
System
time
It is to set system time. It becomes valid after you set.
300
Sync PC
You can click this button to save the system time as your PC current
time.
DST
Here you can set day night save time begin time and end time. You
can set according to the date format or according to the week
format.
NTP
You can check the box to enable NTP function.
NTP server
You can set the time server address.
Port
It is to set the time server port.
Interval
It is to set the sync periods between the device and the time server.
7.8.5.1.3
Holiday Setup
Holiday setup interface is shown as in Figure 7-77.
Here you can check the box here to enable this function and then set.
Figure 7-77
7.8.5.2 Account
Note:
For the character in the following user name or the user group name, system max supports
6-digits. The space in the front or at the end of the string is null. The valid string includes:
character, number, and underline.
The user amount is 20 and the group amount is 8 when the device is shipped out of the
factory. The factory default setup includes two levels: user and admin. You can set the
corresponding group and then set the rights for the respective user in the specified groups.
User management adopts group/user modes. The user name and the group name shall be
unique. One user shall be included in only one group.
7.8.5.2.1
User name
In this interface you can add/remove user and modify user name. See Figure 7-78.
301
Figure 7-78
Add user: It is to add a name to group and set the user rights. See Figure 7-79.
There are four default users: admin/888888/666666 and hidden user “default”. Except user 6666,
other users have administrator right. The user 666666 can only have the monitor rights,.
Hidden user “default” is for system interior use only and can not be deleted. When there is no
login user, hidden user “default” automatically login. You can set some rights such as monitor for
this user so that you can view some channel view without login.
Here you can input the user name and password and then select one group for current user.
Please note the user rights shall not exceed the group right setup.
For convenient setup, please make sure the general user has the lower rights setup than the
admin.
302
Figure 7-79
Modify user
It is to modify the user property, belonging group, password and rights. See Figure 7-80.
Modify password
It is to modify the user password. You need to input the old password and then input the new
password twice to confirm the new setup. Please click the OK button to save.
Please note, the password ranges from 1-digit to 6-digit. It shall include the number only. For the
user of the account rights, he can modify the password of other users.
303
Figure 7-80
7.8.5.2.2
Group
The group management interface can add/remove group, modify group password and etc.
The interface is shown as in Figure 7-81.
Figure 7-81
Add group: It is to add group and set its corresponding rights. See Figure 7-82.
Please input the group name and then check the box to select the corresponding rights. It
includes: shutdown/reboot device, live view, record control, PTZ control and etc.
304
Figure 7-82
Modify group
Click the modify group button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 7-83.
Here you can modify group information such as remarks and rights.
Figure 7-83
7.8.5.3 Display
Display interface includes GUI, TV adjust, Tour and video matrix.
305
7.8.5.3.1
GUI
Here you can set background color and transparency level. See Figure 7-84.
Figure 7-84
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Resolution
There are four options: 1280×1024(default),1280×720,1024×
768,800×600. Please note the system needs to reboot to activate
current setup.
Here is for you to adjust transparency. The value ranges from 128
to 255.
Check the box here, you can view system time and channel
number on the monitor video.
Transparency
Time
title/channel
title
Image
enhance
7.8.5.3.2
Check the box; you can optimize the margin of the preview video.
TV Adjust
It is to set TV output region. See Figure 7-85.
Figure 7-85
7.8.5.3.3
Tour
306
The tour interface is shown as in Figure 7-86. Here you can set tour interval, split mode, motion
detect tour and alarm tour mode.
Figure 7-86
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Enable tour
Check the box here to enable tour function.
Interval
Here is for you to adjust transparency. The value ranges from 5 to
120s. The default setup is 5s.
Here you can set window mode and channel group. System can
support 1/4/8/9/16/25/36-window according to device channel
amount.
Here you can set motion detect tour/alarm tour window mode.
System supports 1/8-window now.
Split
Motion
tour/Alarm
tour
7.8.5.3.4
Video Matrix
The video matrix interface is shown as in Figure 7-87.
Here you can set video matrix output channel and interval. It supports 1/4/9/16 spot tour.
Note:
HD-SDI series product does not support this function,
960H series only supports single-window spot tour.
307
Figure 7-87
7.8.5.4 Default
The default setup interface is shown as in Figure 7-88.
Here you can select Channel/Network/Event/Storage/System. Or you can check the All box to
select all items.
Figure 7-88
7.8.5.5 Import/Export
The interface is shown as in Figure 7-89.
308
Figure 7-89
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Import
It is to import the local setup files to the system.
Export
It is to export the corresponding WEB setup to your local PC.
7.8.5.6 Auto maintenance
The auto maintenance interface is shown as in Figure 7-90.
Here you can select auto reboot and auto delete old files interval from the dropdown list.
If you want to use the auto delete old files function, you need to set the file period.
Figure 7-90
7.8.5.7 Upgrade
The upgrade interface is shown as in Figure 7-91.
Please select the upgrade file and then click the update button to begin update. Please note the
file name shall be as *.bin. During the upgrade process, do not unplug the power cable, network
cable, or shutdown the device.
Important
309
Improper upgrade program may result in device malfunction!
Figure 7-91
7.8.5.8 RS232
The RS232 interface is shown as in Figure 7-92.
Figure 7-92
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Protocol
Select the corresponding dome protocol.
Default setup is console.
Select the baud rate.
Default setup is 115200.
Baud Rate
Data Bit
The value ranges from 5 to 8.
Default setup is 8.
Stop bit
There are two options: 1/2.
Default setup is 1.
Parity
There are five options: none/odd/even/space/mark.
Default setup is none.
7.8.5.9 PTZ
310
The PTZ interface is shown as in Figure 7-93.
Before setup, please check the following connections are right:
PTZ and decoder connection is right. Decoder address setup is right.
Decoder A (B) line connects with DVR A (B) line.
Click Save button after you complete setup, you can go back to the monitor interface to control
speed dome.
Figure 7-93
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Parameter
Function
Channel
Select speed dome connected channel.
Protocol
Select the corresponding dome protocol such as PELCOD..
Address
Set corresponding dome address. Default value is 1. Please note
your setup here shall comply with your dome address; otherwise
you can not control the speed dome.
Select the dome baud rate. Default setup is 9600.
Baud
Rate
Data Bit
Default setup is 8. Please set according to the speed dome dial switch
setup.
Stop bit
Default setup is 1. Please set according to the speed dome dial switch
setup.
Parity
Default setup is none. Please set according to the speed dome dial
switch setup.
7.8.6 Advanced
7.8.6.1 Text Overlay
The card overlay function is for financial areas. It includes Sniffer, information analysis and title
overlay function. The Sniffer mode includes COM and network.
7.8.6.1.1
COM Type
The COM interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-94.
Protocol: Please select from the dropdown list.
Setting: Click COM setting button, the interface is shown as in RS232 interface. Please refer
to Chapter 7.8.5.8 RS232.
Overlay channel: Please select the channel you want to overlay the card number.
311
Overlay mode: There are two options: preview and encode. Preview means overlay the card
number in the local monitor video. Encode means overlay the card number in the record file.
Overlay Position: Here you can select the proper overlay position from the dropdown list.
Figure 7-94
7.8.6.1.2
Network Type
The network type interface is shown as below. See Figure 7-95.
Here we take the ATM/POS protocol to continue.
There are two types: with or without the protocol according to client’s requirements.
With the protocol
For ATM/POS with the protocol, you just need to set the source IP, destination IP (sometimes
you need to input corresponding port number).
Figure 7-95
Without the protocol
For the ATM/POS without the protocol, the interface is shown as in Figure 7-96.
Source IP refers to host IP address that sends out information (usually it is the device host.)
Destination IP refers to other systems that receive information.
Usually you do not need to set source port and target port.
There are total four groups IP. The record channel applies to one group (optional) only.
Six frame ID groups verification can guarantee information validity and legal.
312
Figure 7-96
Click Data button you can set offset value, length, title according to your communication protocol
and data package. .
7.8.7 Information
7.8.7.1 Version
The version interface is shown as in Figure 7-97.
Here you can view system hardware features, software version, release date and etc. Please
note the following information is for reference only.
Figure 7-97
7.8.7.2 Log
Here you can view system log. See Figure 7-98.
313
Figure 7-98
Please refer to the following sheet for log parameter information.
Parameter
Function
Type
Log types include: system operation, configuration operation, data
operation, event operation, record operation, user management, log
clear.
Start time
Set the start time of the requested log.
End time
Set the end time of the requested log.
Search
You can select log type from the drop down list and then click search
button to view the list.
You can click the stop button to terminate current search operation.
You can select one item to view the detailed information.
Detailed
information
Clear
You can click this button to delete all displayed log files. Please note
system does not support clear by type.
Backup
You can click this button to backup log files to current PC.
7.8.7.3 Online User
The online user interface is shown as in Figure 7-99.
314
Figure 7-99
7.9 Search
Click search button, you can see an interface is shown as in Figure 7-100.
Please set record type, record date, window display mode and channel name.
You can click the date on the right pane to select the date. The green highlighted date is system
current date and the blue highlighted date means it has record files.
Figure 7-100
Then please click search button, you can see the corresponding files in the list. See Figure 7-101.
315
Figure 7-101
Select a file you want to play and then click Play button, system can begin playback. You can
select to playback in full-screen. Please note for one channel, system can not playback and
download at the same time. The record is automatically saved at the Download folder of the
installation directory. Or you can download it to your specified directory. You can use the
playback control bar to implement various operations such as play, pause, stop, slow play, fast
play and etc. You can view playback channel and device IP during the playback process.
Select the file(s) you want to download and then click download button, system pops up a
dialogue box shown as in Figure 7-102, then you can specify file name and path to download the
file(s) to your local pc.
Figure 7-102
Load more
It is for you to search record or picture. You can select record channel, record type and record
time to download. See Figure 7-103.
316
Figure 7-103
Remote backup
In Figure 7-103, there is a remote back pane at the left bottom of the pane. It allows you to
backup the record or picture to your local USB storage media via the Web remotely. Click the
search button; you can view the available storage device. See Figure 7-104. Please select file(s)
from the list and then Click Start backup button. Please refer to chapter 7.8.1.2.4 to set device
download path.
Figure 7-104
317
Now you can see system begins backup and the Stop backup button becomes valid. You can
click it to terminate current operation.
At the bottom of the interface, there is a process bar for your reference.
7.10 Alarm
Click alarm function, you can see an interface is shown as Figure 7-105.
Here you can set device alarm type and alarm sound setup.
Figure 7-105
Please refer to the following sheet for detailed information.
Please make sure current device can upload the alarm.
Type
Parameter
Function
Alarm
Video loss
System alarms when video loss occurs.
Type
Motion detection System alarms when motion detection alarm
occurs.
Operation
Camera
masking
Disk full
Disk error
External alarm
Prompt
System alarms when camera is viciously masking.
Alarm
Sound
Play alarm
sound
System alarms when disk is full.
System alarms when disk error occurs.
Alarm input device sends out alarm.
Check the box here, system can automatically
pops up an alarm icon on the Alarm button in the
main interface when there is an alarm.
System sends out alarm sound when an alarm
occurs. You can specify as you wish.
Sound path
Here you can specify alarm sound file.
7.11 Log out
Click log out button, system goes back to log in interface. See Figure 7-106.
You need to input user name and password to login again.
318
Figure 7-106
7.12 UnUn-install Web Control
You can use web un-install tool “uninstall web.bat” to un-install web control.
Please note, before you un-installation, please close all web pages, otherwise the uninstallation might result in error.
319
8 Professional
Professional Surveillance System
Besides Web, you can use our Professional Surveillance Software (PSS) to login the device.
For detailed information, please refer to PSS user’s manual.
320
9 FAQ
1. DVR can not boot up properly.
There are following possibilities:
Input power is not correct.
Power connection is not correct.
Power switch button is damaged.
Program upgrade is wrong.
HDD malfunction or something wrong with HDD ribbon.
Seagate DB35.1,DB35.2,SV35 or Maxtor 17-g has compatibility problem. Please
upgrade to the latest version to solve this problem.
Front panel error.
Main board is damaged.
2. DVR often automatically shuts down or stops running.
There are following possibilities:
Input voltage is not stable or it is too low.
HDD malfunction or something wrong wit the ribbon.
Button power is not enough.
Front video signal is not stable.
Working environment is too harsh, too much dust.
Hardware malfunction.
3. System can not detect hard disk.
There are following possibilities:
HDD is broken.
HDD ribbon is damaged.
HDD cable connection is loose.
Main board SATA port is broken.
4. There is no video output whether it is one-channel, multiple-channel or all-channel
output.
There are following possibilities:
Program is not compatible. Please upgrade to the latest version.
Brightness is 0. Please restore factory default setup.
There is no video input signal or it is too weak.
Check privacy mask setup or your screen saver.
DVR hardware malfunctions.
5. Real-time video color is distorted.
There are following possibilities:
When using BNC output, NTSC and PAL setup is not correct. The real-time video
becomes black and white.
DVR and monitor resistance is not compatible.
Video transmission is too long or degrading is too huge.
321
DVR color or brightness setup is not correct.
6. Can not search local records.
There are following possibilities:
HDD ribbon is damaged.
HDD is broken.
Upgraded program is not compatible.
The recorded file has been overwritten.
Record function has been disabled.
7. Video is distorted when searching local records.
There are following possibilities:
Video quality setup is too low.
Program read error, bit data is too small. There is mosaic in the full screen. Please
restart the DVR to solve this problem.
HDD data ribbon error.
HDD malfunction.
DVR hardware malfunctions.
8. There is no audio when monitor.
There are following possibilities:
It is not a power picker.
It is not a power acoustics.
Audio cable is damaged.
DVR hardware malfunctions.
9. There is audio when monitor but there is no audio when system playback.
There are following possibilities:
Setup is not correct. Please enable audio function
Corresponding channel has no video input. Playback is not continuous when the screen
is blue.
10. Time display is not correct.
There are following possibilities:
Setup is not correct
Battery contact is not correct or voltage is too low.
Crystal is broken.
11. DVR can not control PTZ.
There are following possibilities:
Front panel PTZ error
PTZ decoder setup, connection or installation is not correct.
Cable connection is not correct.
PTZ setup is not correct.
PTZ decoder and DVR protocol is not compatible.
322
PTZ decoder and DVR address is not compatible.
When there are several decoders, please add 120 Ohm between the PTZ decoder A/B
cables furthest end to delete the reverberation or impedance matching. Otherwise the
PTZ control is not stable.
The distance is too far.
12. Motion detection function does not work.
There are following possibilities:
Period setup is not correct.
Motion detection zone setup is not correct.
Sensitivity is too low.
For some versions, there is hardware limit.
13. Can not log in client-end or web.
There are following possibilities:
For Windows 98 or Windows ME user, please update your system to Windows 2000
sp4. Or you can install client-end software of lower version. Please note right now, our
DVR is not compatible with Windows VISTA control.
ActiveX control has been disabled.
No dx8.1 or higher. Please upgrade display card driver.
Network connection error.
Network setup error.
Password or user name is invalid.
Client-end is not compatible with DVR program.
14. There is only mosaic no video when preview or playback video file remotely.
There are following possibilities:
Network fluency is not good.
Client-end resources are limit.
There is multiple-cast group setup in DVR. This mode can result in mosaic. Usually we
do not recommend this mode.
There is privacy mask or channel protection setup.
Current user has no right to monitor.
DVR local video output quality is not good.
15. Network connection is not stable.
There are following possibilities:
Network is not stable.
IP address conflict.
MAC address conflict.
PC or DVR network card is not good.
16. Burn error /USB back error.
There are following possibilities:
Burner and DVR are in the same data cable.
323
System uses too much CPU resources. Please stop record first and then begin backup.
Data amount exceeds backup device capacity. It may result in burner error.
Backup device is not compatible.
Backup device is damaged.
17. Keyboard can not control DVR.
There are following possibilities:
DVR serial port setup is not correct
Address is not correct
When there are several switchers, power supply is not enough.
Transmission distance is too far.
18. Alarm signal can not been disarmed.
There are following possibilities:
Alarm setup is not correct.
Alarm output has been open manually.
Input device error or connection is not correct.
Some program versions may have this problem. Please upgrade your system.
19. Alarm function is null.
There are following possibilities:
Alarm setup is not correct.
Alarm cable connection is not correct.
Alarm input signal is not correct.
There are two loops connect to one alarm device.
21. Record storage period is not enough.
There are following possibilities:
Camera quality is too low. Lens is dirty. Camera is installed against the light. Camera
aperture setup is not correct.
HDD capacity is not enough.
HDD is damaged.
22. Can not playback the downloaded file.
There are following possibilities:
There is no media player.
No DXB8.1 or higher graphic acceleration software.
There is no DivX503Bundle.exe control when you play the file transformed to AVI via
media player.
No DivX503Bundle.exe or ffdshow-2004 1012 .exe in Windows XP OS.
23. Forgot local menu operation password or network password
Please contact your local service engineer or our sales person for help. We can guide you to
solve this problem.
324
24. For the HD-SDI 1080P 1.5U and 2U series product, system loses frames when record
local file or the playback is not smooth.
There are following possibilities:
Close extra stream record function.
Close snapshot function.
Reduce monitor channel amount of the WEB.
Close FTP upload function.
25. When I login via HTTPS, a dialogue says the certificate for this website is for other
address.
Please follow chapter 7.8.2.14.1 to create server certificate.
26. When I login via HTTPS, a dialogue says the certificate is not trusted.
Please follow chapter 7.8.2.14.2 to download root certificate.
27. When I login via HTTPS, a dialogue says the certificate has expired or is not valid yet.
Please make sure your PC time is the same as the device time.
Daily Maintenance
Please use the brush to clean the board, socket connector and the chassis regularly.
The device shall be soundly earthed in case there is audio/video disturbance. Keep the
device away from the static voltage or induced voltage.
Please unplug the power cable before you remove the audio/video signal cable, RS232 or
RS485 cable.
Do not connect the TV to the local video output port (VOUT).It may result in video output
circuit.
Always shut down the device properly. Please use the shutdown function in the menu, or
you can press the power button in the rear pane for at least three seconds to shut down the
device. Otherwise it may result in HDD malfunction.
Please make sure the device is away from the direct sunlight or other heating sources.
Please keep the sound ventilation.
Please check and maintain the device regularly.
325
326
Appendix A HDD Capacity
Capacity Calculation
Calculate total capacity needed by each DVR according to video recording (video recording type
and video file storage time).
Step 1: According to Formula (1) to calculate storage capacity qi that is the capacity of each
channel needed for each hour, unit Mbyte.
q i = d i ÷ 8 × 3600 ÷ 1024
(1)
In the formula: d i means the bit rate, unit Kbit/s
Step 2: After video time requirement is confirmed, according to Formula (2) to calculate the
storage capacity mi , which is storage of each channel needed unit Mbyte.
mi = qi × hi × Di
(2)
In the formula:
hi means the recording time for each day (hour)
Di means number of days for which the video shall be kept
Step 3: According to Formula (3) to calculate total capacity (accumulation) qT that is needed for
all channels in the DVR during scheduled video recording.
c
qT = ∑ mi
(3)
i =1
In the formula: c means total number of channels in one DVR
Step 4: According to Formula (4) to calculate total capacity (accumulation) qT that is needed for
all channels in DVR during alarm video recording (including motion detection).
c
qT = ∑ mi ×a%
(4)
i =1
In the formula:a% means alarm occurrence rate
327
Appendix B Compatible Backup Device List
Compatible USB drive list
NOTE: Please upgrade the DVR firmware to latest version to ensure the accuracy of the table
below. If you use the USB drive, please confirm the format FAT or FAT32.
Manufacturer
Model
Capacity
Sandisk
Cruzer Micro
512M
Sandisk
Cruzer Micro
1G
Sandisk
Cruzer Micro
2G
Sandisk
Cruzer Freedom
256M
Sandisk
Cruzer Freedom
512M
Sandisk
Cruzer Freedom
1G
Sandisk
Cruzer Freedom
2G
Kingston
1G
DataTraveler Ⅱ
Kingston
2G
DataTraveler Ⅱ
Kingston
DataTraveler
1G
Kingston
DataTraveler
2G
Maxell
USB Flash Stick
128M
Maxell
USB Flash Stick
256M
Maxell
USB Flash Stick
512M
Maxell
USB Flash Stick
1G
Maxell
USB Flash Stick
2G
Kingax
Super Stick
128M
Kingax
Super Stick
256M
Kingax
Super Stick
512M
Kingax
Super Stick
1G
Kingax
Super Stick
2G
Netac
U210
128M
Netac
U210
256M
Netac
U210
512M
Netac
U210
1G
Netac
U210
2G
Netac
U208
4G
Teclast
Ti Cool
128M
Teclast
Ti Cool
256M
Teclast
Ti Cool
512M
Teclast
Ti Cool
1G
SanDisk
cruzer mirco
2G
SanDisk
cruzer mirco
8G
SanDisk
Ti Cool
2G
SanDisk
Hongjiao
4G
Lexar
Lexar
256MB
Kingston
Data Traveler
1G
Kingston
Data Traveler
16GB
Kingston
Data Traveler
32GB
Aigo
L8315
16GB
Sandisk
250
16GB
Kingston
Data Traveler Locker+
32GB
Netac
U228
8GB
328
Compatible SD Card List
Please refer to the following sheet for compatible SD card brand.
Brand
Standard
Capacity
Transcend
SDHC6
16GB
Kingston
SDHC4
4GB
Kingston
SD
2GB
Kingston
SD
1GB
Sandisk
SDHC2
8GB
Sandisk
SD
1GB
Card type
SD
SD
SD
SD
Micro-SD
Micro-SD
Compatible Portable HDD List
Please refer to the following sheet for compatible portable HDD brand.
Brand
Model
Capacity
YDStar
YDstar HDD box
40G
Netac
Netac
80G
Iomega RPHD-CG"
Iomega
250GB
RNAJ50U287
WD Elements
WCAVY1205901
1.5TB
Newsmy
Liangjian
320GB
WD Elements
WDBAAR5000ABK-00
500GB
WD Elements
WDBAAU0015HBK-00
1.5TB
Seagate
FreeAgent Go(ST905003F)
500GB
Aigo
H8169
500GB
Compatible USB DVD Burner List
NOTE: Please upgrade the DVR firmware to latest version to ensure the accuracy of the table
below. And you can use the USB cable with the model recommended to set USB burner.
Manufacturer
Model
Sony
DRX-S70U
Benq
TW200D
Compatible SATA DVD Burner List
NOTE: Please upgrade the DVR firmware to latest version to ensure the accuracy of the table
below.
Manufacturer
Model
Pioneer
DVR-215CHG
Panasonic
Samsung
SW-9588-C
TS-H653
Sony
DRU-V200S
Sony
DRU-845S
Samsung
TS-H653
Pioneer
DVR-217CHG
LG
GH22NS30
Compatible SATA HDD List
NOTE: Please upgrade the DVR firmware to latest version to ensure the accuracy of the table
below. And SATA HDD should be used for the DVR with SATA port. Here we recommend HDD
of 500G to 4T capacity.
Port
Manufacturer Series
Model
Capacity
Mode
329
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate SV35.1
Seagate SV35.1
Seagate SV35.2
Seagate SV35.2
Seagate SV35.2
Seagate SV35.2
Seagate SV35.3
Seagate SV35.3
Seagate SV35.3
Seagate SV35.3
Seagate SV35.4
Seagate SV35.4
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate SV35.5
Seagate Pipeline HD
Seagate Pipeline HD
Seagate Pipeline HD
Seagate Pipeline HD
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate Pipeline
HD2
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
ST3250824SV
ST3500641SV
ST3250820SV
ST3320620SV
ST3500630SV
ST3750640SV
ST3250310SV
ST3500320SV
ST3750330SV
ST31000340SV
ST3320410SV
ST3250311SV
ST3500410SV
ST3500411SV
ST31000525SV
ST31000526SV
ST1000VX000
ST2000VX003
ST2000VX002
ST2000VX000
ST3000VX000
ST3320410CS
ST3320310CS
ST3500422CS
ST3500321CS
ST3250412CS
250G
500G
250G
320G
500G
750G
250G
500G
750G
1T
320G
250G
500G
500G
1T
1T
1T
2T
2T
2T
3T
320G
320G
500G
500G
250G
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
ST3320311CS
250G
SATA
ST3500414CS
500G
SATA
ST3500312CS
500G
SATA
ST31000424CS
1T
SATA
ST31000322CS
1T
SATA
ST1000VM002
1T
SATA
ST1500VM002
1T
SATA
ST2000VM002
2T
SATA
ST2000VM003
2T
SATA
ST3500514NS
500G
SATA
ST31000524NS
1T
SATA
ST32000644NS
2T
SATA
ST2000NM0011
2T
SATA
ST1000NM0011
1T
SATA
ST500NM0011
500G
SATA
ST2000NM0031
2T
SATA
330
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Seagate
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Seagate
Constellation ES.2
Cariar SE
ST1000NM0031
1T
SATA
ST500NM0031
500G
SATA
ST2000NM0051
2T
SATA
ST1000NM0051
1T
SATA
ST500NM0051
500G
SATA
ST33000650NS
3T
SATA
ST32000645NS
2T
SATA
ST33000651NS
3T
SATA
ST32000646NS
2T
SATA
ST33000652NS
3T
SATA
ST32000647NS
2T
SATA
WD3200JD
320G
SATA
Cariar SE
WD3000JD
300G
SATA
Cariar SE
WD2500JS
250G
SATA
Cariar SE16
WD7500KS
750G
SATA
Cariar SE16
WD5000KS
500G
SATA
Cariar SE16
WD4000KD
400G
SATA
Cariar SE16
WD3200KS
320G
SATA
Cariar SE16
WD2500KS
250G
SATA
WD Caviar SE16
WD2500YS-01SHB0
250G
SATA
WD Caviar RE16
WD3200YS-01PGB0
320G
SATA
WD Caviar RE2
WD5000YS-01MPB0
500G
SATA
WD AV—AVJS
WD2500AVJS-63WDA0
500G
SATA
WD AV—AVJS
WD3200AVJS-63WDA0
320G
SATA
WD AV—AVJS
WD5000AVJS-63YJA0
500G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVCS
WD5000AVCS-63H1B1
500G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVCS
WD7500AVCS-63ZLB0
750G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVCS
WD3200AVCS
320G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVCS
WD2500AVCS
250G
SATA
331
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Westem
Digital
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Samsung
Hitachi
Hitachi
Hitachi
Hitachi
Maxtor
WDAV-GP—EVCS
WD10EVCS-63ZLB0
1T
SATA
WDAV-GP—EVCS
WD20EVCS-63ZLB0
2T
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVVS
WD3200AVVS-63L2B0
320G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVVS
WD5000AVVS-63ZWB0
500G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVVS
WD7500AVVS-63E1B1
750G
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVVS
WD7500AVVS-63E1B1
750G
SATA
WDAV-GP—EVVS
WD10EVVS-63E1B1
1T
SATA
WDAV-GP—EVDS
WD10EVDS-63N5B1
1T
SATA
WDAV-GP—EVDS
WD15EVDS-63V9B0
1.5T
SATA
WDAV-GP—EVDS
WD20EVDS-63T3B0
2T
SATA
WDAV-GP—AVDS
WD5000AVDS-63U7B0
500G
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD30EURS
3T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD25EURS
2.5T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD20EURS
2T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD15EURS
1.5T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD10EURS
1T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD10EURX
1T
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD7500AURS
750G
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD7500AVDS
500G
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD500AVDS
500G
SATA
WD AV-GP
WD10EUCX
1T
SATA
Samsung—HA
Samsung—HA
Samsung—HA
Samsung—HD
Samsung—HD
Samsung—HD
HitachiCinemaStar™
5K500
HitachiCinemaStar™
7K1000.B
HitachiCinemaStar™
7K1000.B
HitachiCinemaStar™
7K1000.B
DiamondMax 20
HA500LJ/CE
HA751LJ
HA101UJ/CE
HD502HI/CEC
HD103SI/CEC
HD154UI/CE
HCP725050GLA380
500G
750G
1T
500G
1T
1.5T
500G
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
SATA
HCT721050SLA360
500G
SATA
HCT721075SLA360
750G
SATA
HCT721010SLA360
1T
SATA
STM3320820AS
320G
SATA
332
Maxtor
DiamondMax 20
STM3250820AS
250G
SATA
333
APPENDIX C Compatible CD/DVD Device List
NOTE: Please upgrade the DVR firmware to latest version to ensure the accuracy of the table
below. And you can use the USB cable with the model recommended to set USB burner.
Manufacturer
Model
Port Type
Type
Sony
DRX-S50U
USB
DVD-RW
Sony
DRX-S70U
USB
DVD-RW
Sony
AW-G170S
SATA
DVD-RW
Samsung
TS-H653A
SATA
DVD-RW
Panasonic
SW-9588-C
SATA
DVD-RW
Sony
DRX-S50U
USB
DVD-RW
BenQ
5232WI
USB
DVD-RW
334
Appendix D Compatible Displayer List
Please refer to the following sheet for the compatible device brand.
Brand
Model
Dimension (Unit: inch)
BENQ(LCD)
ET-0007-TA
19-inch (wide screen)
DELL(LCD)
E178FPc
17-inch
BENQ(LCD)
Q7T4
17-inch
BENQ(LCD)
Q7T3
17-inch
LENOVO(LCD)
LXB-L17C
17-inch
SANGSUNG(LCD)
225BW
22-inch (wide screen)
HFNOVO (CRT)
LXB-FD17069HB
17-inch
HFNOVO (CRT)
LXB-HF769A
17-inch
HFNOVO (CRT)
LX-GJ556D
17-inch
Samsung(LCD)
2494HS
24-inch
Samsung(LCD)
P2350
23-inch
Samsung(LCD)
P2250
22-inch
Samsung(LCD)
P2370G
23-inch
Samsung(LCD)
2043
20-inch
Samsung(LCD)
2243EW
22-inch
Samsung(LCD)
SMT-1922P
19-inch
Samsung(LCD)
T190
19-inch
Samsung(LCD)
T240
24-inch
LG(LCD)
W1942SP
19-inch
LG(LCD)
W2243S
22-inch
LG(LCD)
W2343T
23-inch
BENQ(LCD)
G900HD
18.5-inch
BENQ(LCD)
G2220HD
22-inch
PHILIPS(LCD)
230E
23-inch
PHILIPS(LCD)
220CW9
23-inch
PHILIPS(LCD)
220BW9
24-inch
PHILIPS(LCD)
220EW9
25-inch
335
Appendix E Compatible Switcher List
Please refer to the following sheet form compatible switcher list.
Brand
Model
D-LinK
DES-1016D
D-LinK
DES-1008D
Ruijie
RG-S1926S
H3C
TP-LINK
TP-LINK
H3C-S1024
TL-SF1016
TL-SF1008+
Network Working Mode
10/100M self-adaptive
10/100M self-adaptive
There are five network
modes:
1、AUTO
2、HALF-10M
3、FULL-10M
4、HALF-100M
5、FULL-100M
10/100M self-adaptive
10/100M self-adaptive
10/100M self-adaptive
336
Appendix F Compatible Wireless Mouse List
Please refer to the following sheet for compatible SD card brand.
Brand
Model
V80
Rapoo
3500
Logitech
M215
Shuangfeiyan
Tianyao G7-630
337
Appendix G Earthing
1. What is the surge?
Surge is a short current or voltage change during a very short time. In the circuit, it lasts for
microsecond. In a 220V circuit, the 5KV or 10KV voltage change during a very short time (about
microseconds) can be called a surge. The surge comes from two ways: external surge and
internal surge.
The external surge: The external surge mainly comes from the thunder lightning. Or it comes
from the voltage change during the on/off operation in the electric power cable.
The internal surge: The research finds 88% of the surge from the low voltage comes from
the internal of the building such as the air conditioning, elevator, electric welding, air
compressor, water pump, power button, duplicating machine and other device of inductive
load.
The lightning surge is far above the load level the PC or the micro devices can support. In most
cases, the surge can result in electric device chip damage, PC error code, accelerating the part
aging, data loss and etc. Even when a small 20 horsepower inductive engine boots up or stops,
the surge can reach 3000V to 50000V, which can adversely affect the electronic devices that use
the same distribution box.
To protect the device, you need to evaluate its environment, the lighting affection degree
objectively. Because surge has close relationship with the voltage amplitude, frequency, network
structure, device voltage-resistance, protection level, ground and etc. The thunder proof work
shall be a systematic project, emphasizing the all-round protection (including building,
transmission cable, device, ground and etc.). There shall be comprehensive management and
the measures shall be scientific, reliable, practical and economic. Considering the high voltage
during the inductive thundering, the International Electrotechnical Committee (IEC) standard on
the energy absorbing step by step theory and magnitude classification in the protection zone, you
need to prepare multiple precaution levels.
You can use the lightning rod, lightning strap or the lightning net to reduce the damage to the
building, personal injury or the property,
The lightning protection device can be divided into three types:
Power lightning arrester: There are 220V single-phrase lightning arrester and 380V threephrase lightening arrester (mainly in parallel connection, sometimes use series connection )
You can parallel connect the power lightning arrester in the electric cable to reduce the
short-time voltage change and release the surge current. From the BUS to the device, there
are usually three levels so that system can reduce the voltage and release the current step
by step to remove the thunderstorm energy and guarantee the device safety. You can select
the replaceable module type, the terminal connection type and portable socket according to
your requirement.
Signal lightning arrester: This device is mainly used in the PC network, communication
system. The connection type is serial connection. Once you connected the signal lightning
arrestor with the signal port, it can cut the channel of the thunderstorm to the device, and on
the other hand, it can discharge the current to the ground to guarantee the device proper
338
work. The signal lightning arrester has many specifications, and widely used in many
devices such as telephone, network, analog communication, digital communication, cable
TV and satellite antenna. For all the input port, especially those from the outdoor, you need
to install the signal lightning arrester.
Antenna feed cable lightning arrester: It is suitable for antenna system of the transmitter or
the device system to receive the wireless signal. It uses the serial connection too.
Please note, when you select the lighting arrester, please pay attention to the port type and the
earthing reliability. In some important environment, you need to use special shielded cable. Do
not parallel connect the thunder proof ground cable with the ground cable of the lightning rod.
Please make sure they are far enough and grounded respectively.
2. The earthing modes
We all know the earthing is the most complicated technology in the electromagnetism
compatibility design since there is no systematic theory or module. The earthing has many
modes, but the selection depends on the system structure and performance. The following are
some successfully experience from our past work.
One-point ground: In the following figure you can see there is a one-point ground. This
connection provides common port to allow signal to be transmitted in many circuits. If there is no
common port, the error signal transmission occurred. In the one-point ground mode, each circuit
is just grounded only and they are connected at the same port. Since there is only one common
port, there is no circuit and so, there is no interference.
Multiple-point ground: In the following figure, you can see the internal circuit uses the chassis
as the common point. While at the same time, all devices chassis use the earthing as the
common port. In this connection, the ground structure can provide the lower ground resistance
because when there are multiple-point grounds; each ground cable is as short as possible. And
the parallel cable connection can reduce the total conductance of the ground conductor. In the
high-frequency circuit, you need to use the multiple-point ground mode and each cable needs to
connect to the ground. The length shall be less than the 1/20 of the signal wavelength.
339
Mixed ground: The mix ground consists of the feature of the one-point ground and multiple-point
ground. For example, the power in the system needs to use the one-point ground mode while the
radio frequency signal requires the multiple-point ground. So, you can use the following figure to
earth. For the direct current (DC), the capacitance is open circuit and the circuit is one-point
ground. For the radio frequency signal, the capacitance is conducive and the circuit adopts
multiple-point ground.
When connecting devices of huge size (the device physical dimension and connection cable is
big comparing with the wave path of existed interference), then there are possibility of
interference when the current goes through the chassis and cable. In this situation, the
interference circuit path usually lies in the system ground circuit.
When considering the earthing, you need to think about two aspects: The first is the system
compatibility, and the other is the external interference coupling into the earth circuit, which
results in system error. For the external interference is not regular, it is not easy to resolve.
3. Thunder proof ground method in the monitor system
The monitor system shall have sound thunder proof earthing to guarantee personnel safety
and device safety.
The monitor system working ground resistance shall be less than 1Ω.
The thunder proof ground shall adopt the special ground cable from the monitor control room
to the ground object. The ground cable adopts copper insulation cable or wire and its ground
section shall be more than 20mm2.
The ground cable of the monitor system can not short circuit or mixed connected with the
strong alternative current cable.
For all the ground cables from the control room to the monitor system or ground cable of
other monitor devices, please use the copper resistance soft cable and its section shall be
more than 4mm2.
340
The monitor system usually can adopt the one-point ground.
Please connect the ground end of 3-pin socket in the monitor system to the ground port of
the system (protection ground cable)
4. The shortcut way to check the electric system using the digital multimeter
For 220V AC socket, from the top to the bottom, E (ground cable), N (neutral cable), L(live cable).
Please refer to the following figure.
There is a shortcut way to check these thee cables connection are standard or not (not the
accurate check).
Importance
In the following operations, the multimeter range shall be at 750V!
For E (earth cable)
Turn the digital multimeter to 750V AC, use your one hand to hold the metal end, and then the
other hand insert the pen to the E port of the socket. See the following figure. If the multimeter
shows 0, then you can see current earth cable connection is standard. If the value is more than
10, then you can see there is inductive current and the earth cable connection is not proper.
341
For L (live cable)
Turn the digital multimeter to 750V AC, use your one hand to hold the metal end, and then the
other hand insert the pen to the L port of the socket. See the following figure. If the multimeter
shows 120, then you can see current live cable connection is standard. If the value is less than
60, then you can see current live cable connection is not proper or it is not the live cable at all.
For N (Neutral cable)
Turn the digital multimeter to 750V AC, use your one hand to hold the metal end, and then the
other hand insert the pen to the N port of the socket. See the following figure. If the multimeter
shows 0, then you can see current N cable connection is standard. If the value is more than 10,
then you can see there is inductive current and the neutral cable connection is not proper. If the
value is 120, then you can know misconnected the neutral cable to the live cable.
342
Appendix H Toxic or Hazardous Materials or Elements
Toxic or Hazardous Materials or Elements
Component
Name
Pb
Hg
Cd
Cr VI
PBB
PBDE
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
Circuit Board
○
○
○
○
○
○
Fastener
Wire and
Cable/Ac
Adapter
Packing
Material
Accessories
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
○
Sheet
Metal(Case)
Plastic Parts
(Panel)
Note
O: Indicates that the concentration of the hazardous substance in all homogeneous materials in
the parts is below the relevant threshold of the SJ/T11363-2006 standard.
X: Indicates that the concentration of the hazardous substance of at least one of all
homogeneous materials in the parts is above the relevant threshold of the SJ/T11363-2006
standard. During the environmental-friendly use period (EFUP) period, the toxic or hazardous
substance or elements contained in products will not leak or mutate so that the use of these
(substances or elements) will not result in any severe environmental pollution, any bodily injury or
damage to any assets. The consumer is not authorized to process such kind of substances or
elements, please return to the corresponding local authorities to process according to your local
government statutes.
Note:
This manual is for reference only. Slight difference may be found in the user interface.
All the designs and software here are subject to change without prior written notice.
All trademarks and registered trademarks mentioned are the properties of their
respective owners.
If there is any uncertainty or controversy, please refer to the final explanation of us.
Please visit our website or contact your local retailer for more information.
343
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertising